blob: 6856463f3e5ea61e821244284968c5b05c00a112 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau5d46fbd2021-02-05 15:17:33 +01007 2021/02/05
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132
1331. Quick reminder about HTTP
134----------------------------
135
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100136When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
138on almost anything found in the contents.
139
140However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
141formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
142correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
143
144
1451.1. The HTTP transaction model
146-------------------------------
147
148The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100149to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100150from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
151connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152will involve a new connection :
153
154 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
155
156In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
157establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
158by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
159length.
160
161Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
162to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
163however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
164response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
165header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
166
167 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
168
169Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
170power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
171but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200172a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100174Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
176second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
177page :
178
179 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
180
181This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
182latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
183correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
184the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100185server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100187The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
188time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
189are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
190parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
191carry the stream identifier.
192
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100193By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
194connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
195leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100196start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
197processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
198waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200199
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200200HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
202 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100203 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200205 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100206
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208
2091.2. HTTP request
210-----------------
211
212First, let's consider this HTTP request :
213
214 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100215 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
217 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
218 3 User-agent: my small browser
219 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
220 5 Accept: image/png
221
222
2231.2.1. The Request line
224-----------------------
225
226Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
227
228 - a METHOD : GET
229 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
230 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
231
232All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
233which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
234followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
235is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
236desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
237the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
238
239The URI itself can have several forms :
240
241 - A "relative URI" :
242
243 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
244
245 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
246 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
247
248 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
249
250 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
251
252 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
253 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
254 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
255 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
256 must accept this form too.
257
258 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
259 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
260 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200262 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
263 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
264 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
265 other protocols too.
266
267In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
268mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
269on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
270It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
271specific to the language, framework or application in use.
272
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100273HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100274assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200276
2771.2.2. The request headers
278--------------------------
279
280The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
281beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
282an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
283Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
284values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
285encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
286the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
287define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
288
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100289Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200290their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100291"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200292as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
293normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
294representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
295HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296
297The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
298that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
299is one valid form of empty line.
300
301Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
302headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
303about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
304application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
305
306Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000307 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
309 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
310 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
311
312
3131.3. HTTP response
314------------------
315
316An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
317messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
318
319 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100320 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200321 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
322 2 Content-length: 350
323 3 Content-Type: text/html
324
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200325As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
326codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
327response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100328continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
329the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
330following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
331sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
332(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
333correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
334such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
335state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
336over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
337if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
338information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003411.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342------------------------
343
344Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
345
346 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
347 - a status code : 200
348 - a reason : OK
349
350The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100351 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
352 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
353 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
354 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
355 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000357Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100358"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
360messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
361or "Authentication Required".
362
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100363HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364
365 Code When / reason
366 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
367 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100370 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200372 400 for an invalid or too large request
373 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
374 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200375 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100376 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100378 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
379 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
381 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100382 501 when haproxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
383 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200385 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
387 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
388 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
389
390The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3914.2).
392
393
3941.3.2. The response headers
395---------------------------
396
397Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
398the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
399details.
400
401
4022. Configuring HAProxy
403----------------------
404
4052.1. Configuration file format
406------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200407
408HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
409
410 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100411 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700412 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100413 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200414
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
416a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100417
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
419
420 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
421
422 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
423 tab characters
424
425 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
426 keyword sequences listed in this document
427
428 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
429 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
430 parts of the configuration, or expressions
431
432 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
433 are supported
434
435 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
436 section
437
438This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
439generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
440figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
441
442First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
443the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
444a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
445word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
446follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
447the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
448the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
449the parts that need to be addressed.
450
451A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
452requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
453extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
454the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
455section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
456section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
457not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
458
459A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
460each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
461a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
462start a new one.
463
464Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
465that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
466applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
467"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
468processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
469ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
470which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
471In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
472of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
473identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
474such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4752, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
476
477 listen foo
478 bind :80
479
480 listen bar
481 bind :81
482
483Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
484spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
485of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
486following configurations are strictly equivalent:
487
488 global#this is the global section
489 daemon#daemonize
490 frontend foo
491 mode http # or tcp
492
493and:
494
495 global
496 daemon
497
498 # this is the public web frontend
499 frontend foo
500 mode http
501
502The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
503new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
504other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
505section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
506section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
507at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
508
509Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
510are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
511editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
512support automatic indent.
513
514In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
515positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
516modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
517anymore, and is not recommended.
518
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200519
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005202.2. Quoting and escaping
521-------------------------
522
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100523In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
524that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
525possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
526in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
527('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200528
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100529This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
530very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
531the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
532also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
533delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
534word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
535remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200536
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100537If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
538(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
539
540Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
541backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200542
543 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
544 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
545 \\ to use a backslash
546 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
547 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
548
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100549In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
550C-language representation:
551
552 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
553 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
554 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
555 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
556
557Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
558or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
559of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200560
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100561 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200562 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
563 # hash as a comment start
564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
566evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
567dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
568backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200569
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
571character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
572is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
575entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
576name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
577represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
578hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200579
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100580 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
581 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
582 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
583 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
584 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
585 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
586 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
587 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
588 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
589 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
590 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200591
592 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100593 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200594 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
595 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
596 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
597 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
598 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
599
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100600There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
601necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
602by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
603they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
604escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
605characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
606case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
607if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
608own quotes.
609
610The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
611quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500612not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100613quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
614
615Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
616arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
617
618 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
619 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
620
621Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
622"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
623cannot write:
624
625 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
626
627because we would like the string to cut like this:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630 |---------|----|-|
631 arg1 _/ / /
632 arg2 __________/ /
633 arg3 ______________/
634
635but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
636parenthesis then garbage:
637
638 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
639 |--------|--------|
640 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
641 trailing garbage _________/
642
643The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
644quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
645processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
646this word:
647
648 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
649 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
650 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
651
652So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
653still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
654the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
655the second level:
656
657 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
658 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
659 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
660 |---------||----|-|
661 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
662 arg2=blah ___________/ /
663 arg3=g _______________/
664
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500665Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100666double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
667
668 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
669 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
670 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
671 |---------||----|-|
672 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
673 arg2 ___________/ /
674 arg3 _______________/
675
676When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
677appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
678string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
679thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
680
681 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
682 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
683 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
684 |-------------| |-----||-|
685 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
686 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
687 arg3 ______________________/
688
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500689Remember that backslahes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100690that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
691quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
692single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
693level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
694
695When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
696double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
697and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
698a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
699a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
700the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
701regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
702around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
703more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200704
705
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007062.3. Environment variables
707--------------------------
708
709HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
710interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
711configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
712optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
713shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200714underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
715list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
716arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
717before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200718
719 Example:
720
721 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
722
723 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
724
725 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
726
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200727Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
728file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200729
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200730* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
731 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
732
733* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
734 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
735 directory.
736
737* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
738
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500739* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200740 processes, separated by semicolons.
741
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500742* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200743 CLI, separated by semicolons.
744
745See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200746
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100747
7482.4. Conditional blocks
749-----------------------
750
751It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
752some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
753ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
754configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
755versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
756preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
757text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
758lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
759switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
760are defined to form conditional blocks:
761
762 - .if <condition>
763 - .elif <condition>
764 - .else
765 - .endif
766
767The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
768as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
769matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
770there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
771only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
772".elif" of a block.
773
774Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
775ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
776as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
777
778The conditions are currently limited to:
779
780 - an empty string, always returns "false"
781 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
782 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
783
784Other patterns are not supported yet but the purpose is to bring a few
785functions to test for certain build options and supported features.
786
787Three other directives are provided to report some status:
788
789 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
790 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
791 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
792
793Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
794"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
795fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
796provide advice to the user.
797
798Example:
799
800 .if "${A}"
801 .if "${B}"
802 .notice "A=1, B=1"
803 .elif "${C}"
804 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
805 .elif "${D}"
806 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
807 .else
808 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
809 .endif
810 .else
811 .notice "A=0"
812 .endif
813
814
8152.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200816----------------
817
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100818Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100819values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
820otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
821numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
822for every keyword. Supported units are :
823
824 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
825 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
826 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
827 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
828 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
829 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
830
831
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01008322.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200833-------------
834
835 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
836 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
837 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
838 global
839 daemon
840 maxconn 256
841
842 defaults
843 mode http
844 timeout connect 5000ms
845 timeout client 50000ms
846 timeout server 50000ms
847
848 frontend http-in
849 bind *:80
850 default_backend servers
851
852 backend servers
853 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
854
855
856 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
857 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
858 global
859 daemon
860 maxconn 256
861
862 defaults
863 mode http
864 timeout connect 5000ms
865 timeout client 50000ms
866 timeout server 50000ms
867
868 listen http-in
869 bind *:80
870 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
871
872
873Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
874
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100875 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200876
877
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008783. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200879--------------------
880
881Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
882are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
883of them have command-line equivalents.
884
885The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
886
887 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200888 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200889 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200890 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200891 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200892 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200893 - description
894 - deviceatlas-json-file
895 - deviceatlas-log-level
896 - deviceatlas-separator
897 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900898 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200899 - gid
900 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100901 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200902 - h1-case-adjust
903 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100904 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100905 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100906 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200907 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200908 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200909 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100910 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200911 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100912 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100913 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200914 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200915 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200916 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200917 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200918 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200919 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100920 - presetenv
921 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200922 - uid
923 - ulimit-n
924 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200925 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100926 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200927 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200928 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200929 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200930 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200931 - ssl-default-bind-options
932 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200933 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200934 - ssl-default-server-options
935 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100936 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200937 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100938 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100939 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100940 - 51degrees-data-file
941 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200942 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200943 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200944 - wurfl-data-file
945 - wurfl-information-list
946 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200947 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100948 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100949
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200950 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100951 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200952 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200953 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200954 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100955 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100956 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100957 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200958 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200959 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200960 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200961 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200962 - noepoll
963 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000964 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100966 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300967 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000968 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100969 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200970 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200971 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200972 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000973 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000974 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200975 - tune.buffers.limit
976 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200977 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200978 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100979 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200980 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200981 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200982 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200983 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100984 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200985 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200986 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200987 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100988 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100989 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100990 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100991 - tune.lua.session-timeout
992 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200993 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100994 - tune.maxaccept
995 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200996 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200997 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200998 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200999 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1000 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001001 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1002 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001003 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001004 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001005 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001006 - tune.sndbuf.client
1007 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001008 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001009 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001010 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001011 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001012 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001013 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001014 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001015 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001016 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001017 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001018 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1019 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1020 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001021 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1022 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001023
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001024 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001025 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001026 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001027
1028
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010293.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001030------------------------------------
1031
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001032ca-base <dir>
1033 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001034 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1035 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1036 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001037
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001038chroot <jail dir>
1039 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1040 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1041 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1042 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1043 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001044 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001045
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001046cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1047 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1048 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1049 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1050 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1051 set. These sets have the format
1052
1053 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1054
1055 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001056 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001057 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1058 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001059 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1060 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001061 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001062 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001063 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001064 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001065 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
1066 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
1067 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
1068 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001069
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001070 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1071 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1072 on the machine's word size.
1073
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001074 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001075 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1076 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1077 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1078 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1079 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1080 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001081
1082 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001083 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1084
1085 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1086 # first 4 CPUs
1087
1088 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1089 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1090 # word size.
1091
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001092 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001093 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001094 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1095 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1096 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1097
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001098 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1099 # and so on.
1100 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1101 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1102 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1103
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001104 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001105 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1106 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1107 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1108
1109 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1110 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1111 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1112
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001113 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1114 # and a thread range.
1115 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1116 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1117 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1118
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001119crt-base <dir>
1120 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001121 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1122 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001123
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001124daemon
1125 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1126 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001127 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1128 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001129
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001130deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1131 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001132 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001133
1134deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001135 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001136 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1137
1138deviceatlas-separator <char>
1139 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1140 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1141
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001142deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001143 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1144 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1145 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001146
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001147external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001148 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1149 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001150 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1151 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1152 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1153 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1154 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001155
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001156gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001157 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001158 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1159 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001160 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1161 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001162 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001163
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001164group <group name>
1165 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1166 See also "gid" and "user".
1167
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001168hard-stop-after <time>
1169 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1170
1171 Arguments :
1172 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1173 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1174 SIGUSR1 signal.
1175
1176 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1177 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1178 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1179
1180 Example:
1181 global
1182 hard-stop-after 30s
1183
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001184h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1185 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1186 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1187 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1188 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001189 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001190 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1191 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1192 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1193 specified in a proxy.
1194
1195 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1196 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1197 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1198 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1199 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1200 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1201 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1202
1203 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1204 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1205 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1206 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1207 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1208
1209 Example:
1210 global
1211 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1212
1213 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1214 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1215
1216h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1217 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1218 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1219 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1220 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1221 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1222 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1223 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1224 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1225
1226 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1227 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1228 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1229
1230 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1231 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1232
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001233insecure-fork-wanted
1234 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1235 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1236 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1237 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1238 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1239 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1240 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1241 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1242 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1243 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1244 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1245 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1246 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1247 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1248 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1249 disable it.
1250
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001251insecure-setuid-wanted
1252 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1253 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1254 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1255 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1256 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1257 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1258 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1259 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1260 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1261 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1262 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1263 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1264 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1265 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1266
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001267issuers-chain-path <dir>
1268 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1269 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1270 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1271 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1272 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1273 "issuers-chain-path".
1274 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1275 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1276 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1277 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1278 will share the chain in memory.
1279
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001280localpeer <name>
1281 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1282 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1283 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1284 the configuration parsing.
1285
1286 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1287 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1288
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001289log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001290 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001291 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001292 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001293 configured with "log global".
1294
1295 <address> can be one of:
1296
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001297 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001298 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1299 port).
1300
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001301 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1302 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1303 port).
1304
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001305 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001306 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1307 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001308 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001309
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001310 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1311 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1312 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1313 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1314 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1315 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1316 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1317 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1318 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1319 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1320 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1321 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1322 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1323 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001324 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1325 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001326
1327 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1328 "fd@2", see above.
1329
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001330 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1331 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1332 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1333 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1334 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1335
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001336 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1337 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001338
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001339 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1340 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1341 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1342 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1343 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1344 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1345 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1346 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1347 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1348 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001349 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1350 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001351
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001352 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1353 one of the following :
1354
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001355 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1356 field is stripped. This is the default.
1357 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1358 rfc3164.
1359
1360 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001361 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1362
1363 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1364 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1365
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001366 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1367 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1368 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1369 designed to be used with a local log server.
1370
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001371 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1372 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1373 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1374 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1375 logger consumes.
1376
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001377 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1378 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1379 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1380 used with a local log server.
1381
1382 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1383 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1384 designed to be used with a local log server.
1385
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001386 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1387 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1388 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1389 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1390
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001391 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1392 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1393 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1394 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1395 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1396
1397 <sample_size>
1398 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1399 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1400 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1401 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1402 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1403
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001404 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001405
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001406 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1407 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1408 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1409
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001410 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1411 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1412 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1413 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001414
1415 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001416 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1417 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1418 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1419 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1420 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1421 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001422
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001423 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001424
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001425log-send-hostname [<string>]
1426 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1427 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1428 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1429 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1430 the logs.
1431
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001432log-tag <string>
1433 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1434 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1435 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001436 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001437
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001438lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001439 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1440 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1441 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1442 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1443 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1444 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001445 used multiple times.
1446
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001447lua-load-per-thread <file>
1448 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1449 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1450 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1451 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1452 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1453 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1454 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1455 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1456 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1457 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1458 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1459 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1460 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1461 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1462 times.
1463
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001464lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1465 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1466 variable.
1467 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1468 to "path".
1469
1470 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1471 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1472 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1473 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1474 will be checked earlier.
1475
1476 As an example by specifying the following path:
1477
1478 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1479 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1480
1481 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1482 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1483 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1484 paths if that does not exist either.
1485
1486 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1487 documentation.
1488
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001489master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001490 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1491 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1492 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001493 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001494 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1495 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001496 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1497 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1498 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1499 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1500 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001501
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001502 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001503
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001504mworker-max-reloads <number>
1505 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001506 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001507 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1508 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1509 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1510
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001511nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001512 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1513 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1514 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001515 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1516 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001517 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1518 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1519 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001520
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001521nbthread <number>
1522 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001523 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1524 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1525 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1526 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1527 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001528 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1529 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1530 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1531 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1532 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1533 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1534 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001535
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001536pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001537 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1538 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1539 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1540 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001541
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001542pp2-never-send-local
1543 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1544 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1545 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1546 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1547 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1548 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1549 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1550 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1551 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1552 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1553 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1554
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001555presetenv <name> <value>
1556 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1557 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1558 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1559 and "unsetenv".
1560
1561resetenv [<name> ...]
1562 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1563 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1564 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1565 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1566 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1567 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1568 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1569 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1570
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001571stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001572 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1573 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1574 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1575 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1576 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1577 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001578 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001579 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1580 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1581 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1582 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001583
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001584server-state-base <directory>
1585 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001586 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1587 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001588
1589server-state-file <file>
1590 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1591 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1592 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1593 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1594 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1595 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1596 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1597 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001598 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1599 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001600
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001601setenv <name> <value>
1602 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1603 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1604 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1605 and "unsetenv".
1606
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001607set-dumpable
1608 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001609 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1610 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1611 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1612 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1613 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1614 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1615 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1616 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1617 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1618 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1619 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1620 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1621 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1622 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1623 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1624 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1625 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001626
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001627ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1628 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1629 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001630 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001631 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001632 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1633 information and recommendations see e.g.
1634 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1635 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1636 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1637 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001638
1639ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1640 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1641 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1642 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1643 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1644 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001645 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1646 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1647 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001648 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001649
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001650ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1651 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1652 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1653 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1654 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1655 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1656
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001657ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1658 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1659 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1660 keyword to see available options.
1661
1662 Example:
1663 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001664 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001665
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001666ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1668 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001669 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001670 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001671 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1672 information and recommendations see e.g.
1673 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1674 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1675 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1676 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1677 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001678
1679ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1680 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1681 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1682 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1683 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1684 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001685 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1686 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1687 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1688 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001689
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001690ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1691 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1692 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1693 keyword to see available options.
1694
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001695ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1696 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1697 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1698 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001699 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001700 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001701 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1702 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1703 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1704 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001705 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1706 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1707 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1708
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001709ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1710 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1711 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001712 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001713 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001714 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1715
1716 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001717
1718 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1719 and won't try to remove them.
1720
1721 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1722
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001723ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001724 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001725 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1726 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001727
1728 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1729 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1730 optimize the startup time.
1731
1732 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1733 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1734 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1735
1736 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001737 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001738
1739 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001740 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1741
1742 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1743 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1744 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1745 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1746 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1747 bind configuration..
1748
1749 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1750 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1751 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1752 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1753 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1754 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1755 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1756 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1757
1758 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1759
1760 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1761 a cert bundle.
1762
1763 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1764 separately in several "crt".
1765
1766 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1767 since files are loading separately.
1768
1769 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1770 required to commit them.
1771
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001772 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001773 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001774
1775 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1776
1777 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1778
1779 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1780 not provided in the PEM file.
1781
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001782 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1783 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1784
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001785 The default behavior is "all".
1786
1787 Example:
1788 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1789 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1790 ssl-load-extra-files none
1791
1792 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1793
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001794ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1795 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1796 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1797 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1798
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001799ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001800 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001801 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1802 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1803 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1804 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1805 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1806 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001807 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001808
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001809stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1810 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1811 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1812 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001813 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001814 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001815
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001816 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1817 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1818 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001819
1820stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1821 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1822 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001823 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001824
1825stats maxconn <connections>
1826 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1827 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1828
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001829uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001830 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001831 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1832 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1833 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1834
1835ulimit-n <number>
1836 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1837 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1838 option.
1839
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001840unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1841 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1842
1843 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1844 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1845 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1846 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1847 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1848 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1849 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1850 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1851 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1852 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1853
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001854unsetenv [<name> ...]
1855 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1856 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1857 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1858 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1859 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1860 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1861 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1862
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001863user <user name>
1864 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1865 See also "uid" and "group".
1866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001867node <name>
1868 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1869
1870 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1871 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1872 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1873 traffic.
1874
1875description <text>
1876 Add a text that describes the instance.
1877
1878 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1879 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1880 "<" and ">" characters.
1881
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100188251degrees-data-file <file path>
1883 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001884 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001885
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001886 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001887 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1888
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000188951degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001890 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1891 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1892 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1893
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001894 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001895 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1896
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200189751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001898 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1899 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1900
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001901 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1902 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1903
190451degrees-cache-size <number>
1905 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1906 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1907 By default, this cache is disabled.
1908
1909 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001910 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1911
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001912wurfl-data-file <file path>
1913 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1914 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1915
1916 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1917 with USE_WURFL=1.
1918
1919wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1920 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1921 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1922 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1923
1924 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1925
1926 Valid WURFL properties are:
1927 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1928
1929 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1930 device.
1931
1932 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1933 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1934
1935 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1936 particular web request.
1937
1938 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1939 used Libwurfl API version.
1940
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001941 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1942 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1943
1944 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1945 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1946
1947 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1948
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001949 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1950 with USE_WURFL=1.
1951
1952wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1953 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1954 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1955
1956 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1957 with USE_WURFL=1.
1958
1959wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1960 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1961 thus before the chroot.
1962
1963 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1964 with USE_WURFL=1.
1965
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001966wurfl-cache-size <size>
1967 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1968 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001969 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001970 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001971
1972 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1973 with USE_WURFL=1.
1974
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001975strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001976 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1977 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1978 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1979 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1980 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001981
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019823.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001983-----------------------
1984
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001985busy-polling
1986 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1987 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1988 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1989 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1990 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1991 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1992 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1993 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1994 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1995 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1996 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1997 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1998 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1999 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2000 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2001 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2002 "poll" pollers.
2003
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002004 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2005 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2006 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2007
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002008max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
2009 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
2010 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2011 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2012 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2013 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2014 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2015 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2016 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2017
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002018maxconn <number>
2019 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2020 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2021 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002022 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2023 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2024 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2025 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002026 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2027 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2028 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2029 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2030 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2031 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002032
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002033maxconnrate <number>
2034 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2035 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2036 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2037 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2038 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2039 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2040 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2041 fairness.
2042
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002043maxcomprate <number>
2044 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002045 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002046 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2047 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2048 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002049 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002050 default value.
2051
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002052maxcompcpuusage <number>
2053 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2054 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2055 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2056 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
2057 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2058 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2059 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2060 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2061
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002062maxpipes <number>
2063 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2064 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2065 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2066 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2067 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2068 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2069
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002070maxsessrate <number>
2071 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2072 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2073 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2074 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2075 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2076 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2077 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2078 fairness.
2079
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002080maxsslconn <number>
2081 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2082 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2083 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2084 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2085 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2086 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2087 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002088 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2089 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2090 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2091 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
2092 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
2093 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2094 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002095
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002096maxsslrate <number>
2097 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2098 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2099 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2100 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2101 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2102 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2103 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2104 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2105 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2106 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2107
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002108maxzlibmem <number>
2109 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2110 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2111 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002112 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2113 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2114 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2115
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002116noepoll
2117 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2118 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002119 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002120
2121nokqueue
2122 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2123 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2124 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2125
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002126noevports
2127 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2128 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2129 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2130 also "nopoll".
2131
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002132nopoll
2133 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2134 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002135 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002136 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2137 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002138
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002139nosplice
2140 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002141 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002142 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002143 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002144 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2145 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2146 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2147 "option splice-response".
2148
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002149nogetaddrinfo
2150 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2151 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2152
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002153noreuseport
2154 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2155 command line argument "-dR".
2156
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002157profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2158 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2159 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2160 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2161 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002162 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002163 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2164 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2165 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2166 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2167
2168 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2169 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2170 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2171 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2172 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002173 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2174 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2175 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2176 CLI.
2177
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002178spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002179 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2180 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2181 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2182 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2183 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2184 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002185
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002186ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002187 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002188 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002189 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2190 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2191 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2192 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2193 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002194 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2195 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002196 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2197 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2198 openssl configuration file uses:
2199 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2200
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002201ssl-mode-async
2202 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002203 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002204 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2205 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2206 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002207 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002208 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002209
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002210tune.buffers.limit <number>
2211 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2212 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2213 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2214 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2215 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002216 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002217 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2218 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2219 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2220 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2221 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2222 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2223 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2224 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2225 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2226
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002227tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2228 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2229 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2230 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2231 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2232
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002233tune.bufsize <number>
2234 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2235 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2236 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2237 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2238 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2239 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2240 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002241 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2242 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2243 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002244 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002245 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2246 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2247 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002248
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002249tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2250 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002251
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002252tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2253 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2254 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2255 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2256 this value. The default value is 1.
2257
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002258tune.fail-alloc
2259 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2260 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2261 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2262 gracefully.
2263
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002264tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2265 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2266 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2267 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2268 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2269 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2270
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002271tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2272 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2273 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2274 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2275 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2276 change it.
2277
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002278tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2279 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002280 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2281 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002282 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2283 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2284 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2285 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2286 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2287
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002288tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2289 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2290 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2291 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2292 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2293 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2294 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2295 recommended not to change this value.
2296
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002297tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2298 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2299 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2300 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2301 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2302 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2303 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2304 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2305
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002306tune.http.cookielen <number>
2307 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2308 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2309 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2310 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2311 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2312 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2313 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2314 to change this value.
2315
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002316tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002317 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2318 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002319 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002320 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002321 configuration directives too.
2322 The default value is 1024.
2323
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002324tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2325 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2326 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2327 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2328 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2329 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2330 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002331 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2332 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2333 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002334
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002335tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2336 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2337 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2338 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2339 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2340 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2341 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
2342 this option to "off". The default is on.
2343
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002344tune.idletimer <timeout>
2345 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2346 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2347 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2348 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2349 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2350 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002351 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002352 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002353 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2354
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002355tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2356 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2357 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2358 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2359 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2360 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2361 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2362 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2363 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2364 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2365
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002366tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2367 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002368 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002369 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2370 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002371 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002372 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2373 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2374
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002375tune.lua.maxmem
2376 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2377 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2378 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2379 memory.
2380
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002381tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2382 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002383 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2384 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002385 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002386
2387tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2388 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2389 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2390 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2391 check servers.
2392
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002393tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2394 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2395 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2396 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002397 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002398
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002399tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002400 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2401 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2402 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2403 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2404 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2405 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2406 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2407 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2408 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2409 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002410
2411tune.maxpollevents <number>
2412 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2413 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2414 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2415 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2416 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2417
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002418tune.maxrewrite <number>
2419 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2420 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2421 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2422 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2423 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2424 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2425 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2426 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2427 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2428 bufsize.
2429
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002430tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2431 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2432 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2433 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2434 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2435 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2436 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2437 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2438 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2439 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002440 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2441 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002442 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2443 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2444 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2445 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2446 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2447 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2448 setting this parameter to 0.
2449
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002450tune.pipesize <number>
2451 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2452 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2453 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2454 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2455 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2456 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2457
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002458tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2459 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2460 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2461 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2462 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2463 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2464 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002465 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002466
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002467tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2468 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2469 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2470 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2471 default is 20.
2472
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002473tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2474tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2475 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2476 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2477 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002478 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002479 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002480 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2481 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2482
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002483tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002484 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002485 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2486 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2487 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2488 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2489
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002490tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002491 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002492 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002493 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2494 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2495 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2496
2497tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2498 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2499 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2500 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2501 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2502 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2503 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2504 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2505 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2506 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002507
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002508tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2509tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2510 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2511 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2512 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002513 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002514 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002515 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2516 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2517 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2518 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2519 notifying haproxy again.
2520
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002521tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002522 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2523 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2524 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002525 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002526 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002527 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002528 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2529 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2530 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002531 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2532 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002533
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002534tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002535 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002536 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2537 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2538 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2539 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2540 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2541
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002542tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2543 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2544 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2545 performances. This is disabled by default.
2546
2547 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2548 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2549
2550 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2551
2552 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2553
2554 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2555
2556 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2557 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2558 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2559
2560 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2561 converted.
2562
2563 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2564 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2565 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2566 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2567 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2568 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2569 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002570 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2571 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002572
2573 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2574
2575 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2576 only need this line:
2577
2578 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2579
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002580tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2581 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002582 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002583 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2584 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2585 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2586 being used for too long.
2587
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002588tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2589 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2590 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2591 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2592 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2593 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2594 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2595 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2596 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2597 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2598 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002599 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002600 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002601
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002602tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2603 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2604 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2605 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2606 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002607 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002608 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2609 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002610 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2611 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002612
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002613tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2614 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2615 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2616 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2617 1000 entries.
2618
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002619tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2620 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2621 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2622 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2623
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002624tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002625tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002626tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2627tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2628tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002629 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2630 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2631 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2632 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2633 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2634 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2635 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2636 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002637
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002638 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2639 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2640 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2641 all available space is consumed.
2642 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2643 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2644 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002645
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002646tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2647 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002648 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002649 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002650 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002651 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2652
2653tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2654 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2655 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002656 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2657 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002658
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026593.3. Debugging
2660--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002661
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002662quiet
2663 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2664 line argument "-q".
2665
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002666zero-warning
2667 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2668 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2669 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2670 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2671 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2672 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2673
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002674
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010026753.4. Userlists
2676--------------
2677It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2678http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2679it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2680
2681userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002682 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002683 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2684
2685group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002686 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002687 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2688 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2689
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002690user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2691 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002692 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2693 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002694 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2695 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2696 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2697 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002698
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002699 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2700 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2701 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2702 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2703 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2704 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2705 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2706 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2707 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002708
2709 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002710 userlist L1
2711 group G1 users tiger,scott
2712 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002713
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002714 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2715 user scott insecure-password elgato
2716 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002717
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002718 userlist L2
2719 group G1
2720 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002721
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002722 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2723 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2724 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002725
2726 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002727
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002728
27293.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002730----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002731It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2732several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2733instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2734values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2735automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2736In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2737using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2738tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2739reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2740Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2741that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2742each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002743
2744peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002745 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002746 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2747
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002748bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2749 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2750 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2751
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002752disabled
2753 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2754 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2755 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2756
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002757default-bind [param*]
2758 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2759
2760default-server [param*]
2761 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2762
2763 Arguments:
2764 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2765 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2766 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2767 details.
2768
2769
2770 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2771
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002772enable
2773 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2774
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002775log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002776 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2777 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2778 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2779 more details.
2780
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002781peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002782 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2783 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002784 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2785 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2786 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2787 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2788 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002789
2790 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2791 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2792
2793 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002794 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2795 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2796 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002797
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002798 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2799 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002800
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002801 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2802 "server" keyword explanation below).
2803
2804server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002805 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002806 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2807 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2808 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2809 of this "peers" section).
2810 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2811
2812
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002813 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002814 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002815 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002816 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2817 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2818 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002819
2820 backend mybackend
2821 mode tcp
2822 balance roundrobin
2823 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2824 stick on src
2825
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002826 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2827 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002828
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002829 Example:
2830 peers mypeers
2831 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2832 default-server ssl verify none
2833 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2834 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002835
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002836
2837table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2838 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2839
2840 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2841 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002842 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002843 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2844 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2845 "stick-table" keyword).
2846
2847 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2848 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2849 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2850 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2851 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2852 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2853 of the stick-table name as follows:
2854
2855 peers mypeers
2856 peer A ...
2857 peer B ...
2858 table t1 ...
2859
2860 frontend fe1
2861 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2862
2863 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2864 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2865
2866 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2867 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2868 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2869 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2870 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2871 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2872 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2873
2874 peers mypeers
2875 peer A ...
2876 peer B ...
2877 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2878
2879 backend t1
2880 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2881
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002882 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002883 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2884 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2885
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090028863.6. Mailers
2887------------
2888It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2889If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2890in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2891
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002892mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002893 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2894 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2895
2896mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2897 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2898
2899 Example:
2900 mailers mymailers
2901 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2902 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2903
2904 backend mybackend
2905 mode tcp
2906 balance roundrobin
2907
2908 email-alert mailers mymailers
2909 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2910 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2911
2912 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2913 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2914
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002915timeout mail <time>
2916 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2917 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2918 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2919 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2920
2921 Example:
2922 mailers mymailers
2923 timeout mail 20s
2924 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002925
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020029263.7. Programs
2927-------------
2928In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2929master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2930managed the same way as the workers.
2931
2932During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2933sequence as a worker:
2934
2935 - the master is re-executed
2936 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2937 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2938 instance of the program
2939
2940During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2941
2942program <name>
2943 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2944 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2945 the management guide).
2946
2947command <command> [arguments*]
2948 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2949 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2950 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2951 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2952
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002953user <user name>
2954 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2955 See also "group".
2956
2957group <group name>
2958 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2959 See also "user".
2960
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002961option start-on-reload
2962no option start-on-reload
2963 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2964 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2965 program section.
2966
2967
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010029683.8. HTTP-errors
2969----------------
2970
2971It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2972imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2973several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2974
2975http-errors <name>
2976 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2977 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2978
2979errorfile <code> <file>
2980 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2981
2982 Arguments :
2983 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002984 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01002985 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002986
2987 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2988 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2989 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2990 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2991 before any chroot is performed.
2992
2993 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2994
2995 Example:
2996 http-errors website-1
2997 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2998 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2999 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3000
3001 http-errors website-2
3002 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3003 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3004 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3005
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020030063.9. Rings
3007----------
3008
3009It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3010servers or traces.
3011
3012ring <ringname>
3013 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3014
3015description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003016 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003017 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3018
3019format <format>
3020 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3021
3022 Arguments:
3023 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3024 one of the following :
3025
3026 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3027 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3028 designed to be used with a local log server.
3029
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003030 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3031 field is stripped. This is the default.
3032 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3033 rfc3164.
3034
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003035 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3036 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3037 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3038 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3039 is the default.
3040
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003041 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003042 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3043
3044 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3045 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3046
3047 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3048 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3049 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3050 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3051 logger consumes.
3052
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003053 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3054 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3055 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3056 with a local log server.
3057
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003058 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3059 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3060 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3061 used with a local log server.
3062
3063maxlen <length>
3064 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3065 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3066 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3067
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003068server <name> <address> [param*]
3069 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3070 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3071 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3072 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3073 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3074 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3075 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3076 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3077 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003078 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3079 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003080
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003081size <size>
3082 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3083 set to BUFSIZE.
3084
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003085timeout connect <timeout>
3086 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3087
3088 Arguments :
3089 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3090 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3091 as explained at the top of this document.
3092
3093timeout server <timeout>
3094 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3095
3096 Arguments :
3097 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3098 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3099 as explained at the top of this document.
3100
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003101 Example:
3102 global
3103 log ring@myring local7
3104
3105 ring myring
3106 description "My local buffer"
3107 format rfc3164
3108 maxlen 1200
3109 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003110 timeout connect 5s
3111 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003112 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003113
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020031143.10. Log forwarding
3115-------------------
3116
3117It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3118haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3119
3120log-forward <name>
3121 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3122
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003123backlog <conns>
3124 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3125 on connections accept.
3126
3127bind <addr> [param*]
3128 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003129 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3130 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3131 syslog protocol over TCP.
3132 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003133 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3134
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003135dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003136 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3137 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3138 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3139 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003140 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003141
3142log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003143log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003144 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3145 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3146 documentation.
3147 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3148 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3149 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3150 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3151 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3152
3153 Example:
3154 global
3155 log stderr format iso local7
3156
3157 ring myring
3158 description "My local buffer"
3159 format rfc5424
3160 maxlen 1200
3161 size 32764
3162 timeout connect 5s
3163 timeout server 10s
3164 # syslog tcp server
3165 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3166
3167 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003168 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3169 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003170 # all messages on stderr
3171 log global
3172 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3173 log ring@myring local0
3174 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3175 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3176 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3177 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3178 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003179
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003180maxconn <conns>
3181 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3182 10 is the default.
3183
3184timeout client <timeout>
3185 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031874. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003188----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003189
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003190Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003191 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3192 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3193 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3194 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003195
3196A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3197connections.
3198
3199A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3200to forward incoming connections.
3201
3202A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3203parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3204
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003205A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3206ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3207sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3208the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3209explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3210from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3211"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3212for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3213to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3214optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3215are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3216any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3217names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3218that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3219duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3220names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3221
3222Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3223settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3224of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3225profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3226timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3227
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003228All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3229'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3230case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3231
3232Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3233logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3234proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3235However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3236name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3237
3238Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3239and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003240bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003241protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3242modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3243arbitrary criteria.
3244
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003245In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3246a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003247the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003248
3249 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3250 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3251 between responses and new requests.
3252
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003253 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3254 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3255 client-facing connection remains open.
3256
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003257 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3258 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003259
3260The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3261frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3262following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003263weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003264
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003265 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003266
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003267 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3268 ----+-----+-----+----
3269 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3270 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003271 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3272 ----+-----+-----+----
3273 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003274
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003275
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003276
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020032774.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3278--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003280The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3281limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3282they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3283limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003284marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003285option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003286and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3287with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3288specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003289
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003290
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003291 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3292------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3293acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003294backlog X X X -
3295balance X - X X
3296bind - X X -
3297bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003298capture cookie - X X -
3299capture request header - X X -
3300capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003301clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3302clitcpka-idle X X X -
3303clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003304compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003305cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003306declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003307default-server X - X X
3308default_backend X X X -
3309description - X X X
3310disabled X X X X
3311dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003312email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003313email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003314email-alert mailers X X X X
3315email-alert myhostname X X X X
3316email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003317enabled X X X X
3318errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003319errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003320errorloc X X X X
3321errorloc302 X X X X
3322-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3323errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003324force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003325filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003326fullconn X - X X
3327grace X X X X
3328hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003329http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003330http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003331http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003332http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003333http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003334http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003335http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003336http-check set-var X - X X
3337http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003338http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003339http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003340http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003341http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003342http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003343id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003344ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003345load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003346log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003347log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003348log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003349log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003350max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003351maxconn X X X -
3352mode X X X X
3353monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003354monitor-uri X X X -
3355option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3356option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3357option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3358option allbackups (*) X - X X
3359option checkcache (*) X - X X
3360option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3361option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003362option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003363option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3364option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003365-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3366option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003367option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3368option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003369option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003370option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003371option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003372option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003373option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003374option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3375option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3376option httpchk X - X X
3377option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003378option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003379option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003380option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003381option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003382option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003383option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3384option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3385option logasap (*) X X X -
3386option mysql-check X - X X
3387option nolinger (*) X X X X
3388option originalto X X X X
3389option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003390option pgsql-check X - X X
3391option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003392option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003393option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003394option smtpchk X - X X
3395option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3396option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3397option splice-request (*) X X X X
3398option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003399option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003400option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3401option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3402-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003403option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003404option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3405option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3406option tcpka X X X X
3407option tcplog X X X X
3408option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003409external-check command X - X X
3410external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003411persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3412rate-limit sessions X X X -
3413redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003414-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003415retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003416retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003417server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003418server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003419server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003420source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003421srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3422srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3423srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003424stats admin - X X X
3425stats auth X X X X
3426stats enable X X X X
3427stats hide-version X X X X
3428stats http-request - X X X
3429stats realm X X X X
3430stats refresh X X X X
3431stats scope X X X X
3432stats show-desc X X X X
3433stats show-legends X X X X
3434stats show-node X X X X
3435stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003436-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3437stick match - - X X
3438stick on - - X X
3439stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003440stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003441stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003442tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003443tcp-check connect X - X X
3444tcp-check expect X - X X
3445tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003446tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003447tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003448tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003449tcp-check set-var X - X X
3450tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003451tcp-request connection - X X -
3452tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003453tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003454tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003455tcp-response content - - X X
3456tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003457timeout check X - X X
3458timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003459timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003460timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003461timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3462timeout http-request X X X X
3463timeout queue X - X X
3464timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003465timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003466timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003467timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003468transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003469unique-id-format X X X -
3470unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003471use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003472use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003473use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003474------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3475 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003476
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003477
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034784.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3479---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003480
3481This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3482
3483
3484acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3485 Declare or complete an access list.
3486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3487 no | yes | yes | yes
3488 Example:
3489 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3490 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3491 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3492
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003493 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003494
3495
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003496backlog <conns>
3497 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3499 yes | yes | yes | no
3500 Arguments :
3501 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3502 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003503 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003504
3505 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3506 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3507 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3508 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3509 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3510 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3511 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3512 backlog parameter.
3513
3514 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3515 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3516 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3517
3518 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3519
3520
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003521balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003522balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003523 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3525 yes | no | yes | yes
3526 Arguments :
3527 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3528 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3529 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3530 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3531
3532 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3533 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3534 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3535 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003536 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003537 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003538 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3539 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3540 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3541 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3542 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3543 it, so that you don't worry.
3544
3545 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3546 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3547 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3548 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3549 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3550 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3551 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3552 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003553
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003554 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3555 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3556 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3557 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3558 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3559 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3560 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003561 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3562 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3563 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003564
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003565 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003566 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003567 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3568 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003569 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003570 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3571 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3572 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3573 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3574 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003575 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3576 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3577 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3578 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3579 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3580 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003581
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003582 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3583 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3584 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3585 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3586 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3587 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3588 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3589 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003590 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003591 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003592 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3593 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3594 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003595
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003596 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3597 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3598 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3599 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3600 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3601 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3602 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3603 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3604 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3605 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3606 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3607 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003608
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003609 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003610 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3611 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3612 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3613 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3614 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3615 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3616 URIs start with a leading "/".
3617
3618 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3619 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3620 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3621 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3622
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003623 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3624 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3625 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3626 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3627
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003628 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003629 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3630
3631 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003632 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3633 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003634 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3635 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3636 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3637 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003638 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003639 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3640 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003641
3642 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3643 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3644 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3645 server will receive the request.
3646
3647 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3648 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3649 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3650 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3651 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003652 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3653 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3654 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003655
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003656 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3657 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3658 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3659 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3660 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003661
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003662 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003663 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3664 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3665 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3666
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003667 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3668 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3669 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3670
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003671 random
3672 random(<draws>)
3673 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003674 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3675 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3676 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3677 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003678 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3679 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3680 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3681 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3682 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3683 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3684 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3685 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3686 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3687 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3688 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3689 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3690 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3691 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3692 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3693 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3694 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3695 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3696 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3697 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003698
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003699 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003700 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003701 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3702 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3703 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3704 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3705 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3706 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003707 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003708 used instead.
3709
3710 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3711 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3712 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3713 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3714
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003715 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3716 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3717 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3718
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003719 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003720
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003721 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003722 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3723 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003724
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003725 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3726 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3727 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003728
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003729 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003730 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003731 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3732 NTLM relies on.
3733
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003734 Examples :
3735 balance roundrobin
3736 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003737 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003738 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3739 balance hdr(host)
3740 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003741
3742 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3743 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3744
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003745 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003746 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3747 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3748 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003749 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003750
3751 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3752 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3753 defaults to 16 kB.
3754
3755 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3756 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3757
3758 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3759 Round Robin.
3760
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003761 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003762 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3763 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3764 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3765
3766 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3767
3768 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003769 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003770 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3771 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3772 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003773
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003774 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003775
3776
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003777bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3778bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003779 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3781 no | yes | yes | no
3782 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003783 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3784 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3785 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3786 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003787 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003788 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3789 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3790 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3791 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3792 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3793 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003794 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003795 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3796 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003797 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003798 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3799 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003800 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003801 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3802 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003803 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003804 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3805 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3806 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3807 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3808 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3809 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3810 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003811 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3812 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3813 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003814 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3815 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3816 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3817 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003818 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3819 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3820 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003821
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003822 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3823 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003824 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3825 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3826 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003827 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3828 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3829 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3830 the range.
3831
3832 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3833 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3834 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3835 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3836 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3837 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3838 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003839 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003840 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003841
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003842 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003843 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003844 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3845 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3846 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3847 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3848 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3849 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3850
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003851 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3852 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3853 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3854 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003855
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003856 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3857 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3858 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3859 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3860 in a frontend.
3861
3862 Example :
3863 listen http_proxy
3864 bind :80,:443
3865 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003866 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003867
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003868 listen http_https_proxy
3869 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003870 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003871
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003872 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3873 bind ipv6@:80
3874 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3875 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3876
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003877 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003878 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003879
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003880 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3881 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3882 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3883 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3884 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3885
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003886 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003887 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003888
3889
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003890bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003891 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3893 yes | yes | yes | yes
3894 Arguments :
3895 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3896 may be used to override a default value.
3897
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003898 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003899 option may be combined with other numbers.
3900
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003901 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003902 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3903 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3904 missing from all processes.
3905
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003906 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003907 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003908 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3909 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3910 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3911 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3912 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003913 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003914
3915 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3916 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3917 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3918 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3919 and 'even' instances.
3920
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003921 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3922 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3923 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3924 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003925
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003926 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3927 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3928
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003929 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3930 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3931 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3932
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003933 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3934 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3935
3936 Example :
3937 listen app_ip1
3938 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003939 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003940
3941 listen app_ip2
3942 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003943 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003944
3945 listen management
3946 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003947 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003948
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003949 listen management
3950 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3951 bind-process 1-4
3952
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003953 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003954
3955
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003956capture cookie <name> len <length>
3957 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3959 no | yes | yes | no
3960 Arguments :
3961 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3962 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3963 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3964 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003965 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003966
3967 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3968 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3969 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3970 right if it exceeds <length>.
3971
3972 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3973 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3974 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3975 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3976
3977 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3978 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3979 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3980
3981 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3982 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3983 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003984 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3985 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3986 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003987
3988 Example:
3989 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3990
3991 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003992 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003993
3994
3995capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003996 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3998 no | yes | yes | no
3999 Arguments :
4000 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004001 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004002 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4003 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4004 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4005
4006 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4007 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4008 it exceeds <length>.
4009
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004010 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004011 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4012 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004013 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4014 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4015 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4016 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004017 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004018 environments to find where the request came from.
4019
4020 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4021 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4022 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4023 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004024
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004025 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4026 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4027 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4028 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4029 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004030
4031 Example:
4032 capture request header Host len 15
4033 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004034 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004035
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004036 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004037 about logging.
4038
4039
4040capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004041 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4043 no | yes | yes | no
4044 Arguments :
4045 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004046 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004047 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4048 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4049 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4050
4051 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4052 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4053 it exceeds <length>.
4054
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004055 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004056 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4057 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4058 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004059 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4060 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4061 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4062 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004063
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004064 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4065 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4066 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4067 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4068 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004069
4070 Example:
4071 capture response header Content-length len 9
4072 capture response header Location len 15
4073
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004074 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004075 about logging.
4076
4077
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004078clitcpka-cnt <count>
4079 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4080 the connection on the client side.
4081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4082 yes | yes | yes | no
4083 Arguments :
4084 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4085
4086 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4087 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004088 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4089 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004090
4091 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4092
4093
4094clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4095 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4096 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4097 client side.
4098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4099 yes | yes | yes | no
4100 Arguments :
4101 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4102 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4103 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4104 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4105
4106 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4107 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004108 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4109 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004110
4111 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4112
4113
4114clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4115 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4117 yes | yes | yes | no
4118 Arguments :
4119 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4120 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4121 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4122 document.
4123
4124 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4125 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004126 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4127 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004128
4129 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4130
4131
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004132compression algo <algorithm> ...
4133compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004134compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004135 Enable HTTP compression.
4136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4137 yes | yes | yes | yes
4138 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004139 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4140 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4141 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4142
4143 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004144 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4145 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4146 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004147
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004148 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004149 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004150
4151 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4152 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4153 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4154 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4155 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004156 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004157
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004158 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4159 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4160 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4161 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4162 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4163 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4164 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004165 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004166
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004167 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004168 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004169 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4170 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4171 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4172 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4173 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004174
4175 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4176 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4177 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4178 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4179 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004180 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4181 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4182 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4183 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4184 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004185 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4186 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004187
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004188 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004189 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4190 "Accept-Encoding" header
4191 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004192 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004193 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4194 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4195 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4196 "multipart"
4197 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4198 header
4199 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4200 and later
4201 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4202 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004203 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004204
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004205 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004206
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004207 Examples :
4208 compression algo gzip
4209 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004210
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004211
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004212cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004213 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4214 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004215 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004216 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4218 yes | no | yes | yes
4219 Arguments :
4220 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4221 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4222 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4223 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4224 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4225 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004226 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004227 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4228 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4229
4230 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4231 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4232 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4233 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4234 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4235 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004236 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4237 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004238 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004239 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4240 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004241
4242 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004243 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004244
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004245 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004246 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004247 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004248 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004249 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4250 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4251 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4252 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4253 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4254 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4255 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004256
4257 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4258 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4259 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4260 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4261 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4262 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4263 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4264 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4265 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004266 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004267 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4268 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4269 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004270
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004271 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4272 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4273 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004274 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4275 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4276 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4277 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004278 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4279 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4280 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004281
4282 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4283 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4284 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4285 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4286 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4287 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4288 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4289 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4290 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4291
4292 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4293 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4294 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4295 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4296 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4297 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4298 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4299 persistence cookie in the cache.
4300 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4301
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004302 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4303 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4304 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4305 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4306 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004307 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004308 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4309 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4310 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4311 they logout.
4312
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004313 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4314 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4315 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4316 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4317
4318 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4319 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4320 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4321 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4322 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4323 this attribute.
4324
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004325 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004326 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004327 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4328 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4329 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4330 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4331 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4332 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004333
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004334 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4335 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4336 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4337 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4338 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4339 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4340 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4341 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004342 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004343 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4344 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4345 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4346 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4347 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4348 the site.
4349
4350 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4351 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4352 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4353 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4354 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4355 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4356 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4357 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4358 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4359 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4360 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4361 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4362 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004363 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004364 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4365 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4366
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004367 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4368 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4369 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4370 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4371 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4372 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4373
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004374 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4375 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4376 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4377 repeated.
4378
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004379 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4380 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4381 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4382 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004383
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004384 Examples :
4385 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4386 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4387 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004388 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004389
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004390 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004391
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004392
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004393declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4394 Declares a capture slot.
4395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4396 no | yes | yes | no
4397 Arguments:
4398 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4399
4400 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4401 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4402 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4403 for use in the response.
4404
4405 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004406 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004407 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4408
4409
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004410default-server [param*]
4411 Change default options for a server in a backend
4412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4413 yes | no | yes | yes
4414 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004415 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4416 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4417 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4418 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004419
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004420 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004421 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4422
4423 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004424
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004425
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004426default_backend <backend>
4427 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4429 yes | yes | yes | no
4430 Arguments :
4431 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4432
4433 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4434 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4435 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4436 will catch all undetermined requests.
4437
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004438 Example :
4439
4440 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4441 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4442 default_backend dynamic
4443
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004444 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004445
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004446
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004447description <string>
4448 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4450 no | yes | yes | yes
4451 Arguments : string
4452
4453 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4454 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4455 it describes.
4456 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4457
4458
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004459disabled
4460 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4462 yes | yes | yes | yes
4463 Arguments : none
4464
4465 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4466 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4467 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4468 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4469 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4470 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4471 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4472
4473 See also : "enabled"
4474
4475
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004476dispatch <address>:<port>
4477 Set a default server address
4478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4479 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004480 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004481
4482 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4483 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4484 during start-up.
4485
4486 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4487 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4488 possible with normal servers.
4489
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004490 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004491 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4492 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4493 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4494 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4495
4496 See also : "server"
4497
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004498
4499dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4500 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4502 yes | no | yes | yes
4503 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4504
4505 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004506 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004507 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4508 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004509 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004510 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004511
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004512enabled
4513 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4515 yes | yes | yes | yes
4516 Arguments : none
4517
4518 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4519 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4520
4521 See also : "disabled"
4522
4523
4524errorfile <code> <file>
4525 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4527 yes | yes | yes | yes
4528 Arguments :
4529 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004530 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004531 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004532
4533 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004534 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004535 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004536 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4537 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004538
4539 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4540 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4541 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4542
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004543 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4544
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004545 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4546 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4547 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4548 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4549 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4550 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4551 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4552 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4553 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004554
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004555 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4556 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4557 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004558 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004559 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4560
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004561 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004562
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004563 Example :
4564 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004565 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004566 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4567 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4568
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004569
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004570errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4571 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4572 section.
4573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4574 yes | yes | yes | yes
4575 Arguments :
4576 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4577
4578 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004579 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004580 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4581 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004582
4583 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4584 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4585 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4586 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4587 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004588 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004589 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4590
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004591 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4592 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004593
4594 Example :
4595 errorfiles generic
4596 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4597
4598
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004599errorloc <code> <url>
4600errorloc302 <code> <url>
4601 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4603 yes | yes | yes | yes
4604 Arguments :
4605 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004606 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004607 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004608
4609 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4610 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4611 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4612 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004613 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004614
4615 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4616 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4617 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4618
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004619 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4620
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004621 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4622 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4623 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4624 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004625 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004626 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4627 request.
4628
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004629 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004630
4631
4632errorloc303 <code> <url>
4633 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4635 yes | yes | yes | yes
4636 Arguments :
4637 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004638 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004639 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004640
4641 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4642 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4643 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4644 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004645 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004646
4647 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4648 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4649 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4650
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004651 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4652
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004653 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4654 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4655 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4656 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004657 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004658
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004659 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004660
4661
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004662email-alert from <emailaddr>
4663 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004664 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004665 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4666 yes | yes | yes | yes
4667
4668 Arguments :
4669
4670 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4671
4672 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4673 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4674
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004675 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004676 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4677 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004678
4679
4680email-alert level <level>
4681 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4682 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4683 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4684 yes | yes | yes | yes
4685
4686 Arguments :
4687
4688 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4689 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4690 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4691
4692 By default level is alert
4693
4694 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4695 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4696 for the proxy.
4697
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004698 Alerts are sent when :
4699
4700 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4701 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4702 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4703 is notice or lower
4704 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4705 and a health check status update occurs
4706
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004707 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4708 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004709 section 3.6 about mailers.
4710
4711
4712email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4713 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4714 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4715 yes | yes | yes | yes
4716
4717 Arguments :
4718
4719 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4720
4721 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4722 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4723
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004724 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4725 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004726
4727
4728email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4729 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4730 mailers.
4731 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4732 yes | yes | yes | yes
4733
4734 Arguments :
4735
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004736 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004737
4738 By default the systems hostname is used.
4739
4740 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4741 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4742 for the proxy.
4743
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004744 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4745 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004746
4747
4748email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004749 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004750 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4751 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4752 yes | yes | yes | yes
4753
4754 Arguments :
4755
4756 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4757
4758 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4759 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4760
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004761 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004762 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4763
4764
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004765force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4766 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4767 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004768 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004769
4770 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4771 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4772 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4773 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4774 marked down for maintenance operations.
4775
4776 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4777 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4778 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4779 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4780 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4781 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4782 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4783 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4784 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4785
4786 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4787 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4788 is used.
4789
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004790 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004791 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004792
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004793
4794filter <name> [param*]
4795 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4797 no | yes | yes | yes
4798 Arguments :
4799 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4800 referenced in section 9.
4801
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004802 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004803 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004804 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4805 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004806
4807 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4808 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4809
4810 Example:
4811 listen
4812 bind *:80
4813
4814 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4815 filter compression
4816 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4817
4818 compression algo gzip
4819 compression offload
4820
4821 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4822
4823 See also : section 9.
4824
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004825
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004826fullconn <conns>
4827 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4829 yes | no | yes | yes
4830 Arguments :
4831 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4832 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4833
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004834 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004835 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004836 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004837 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4838 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4839 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4840 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4841 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004842 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004843
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004844 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4845 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004846 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4847 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4848 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004849
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004850 Example :
4851 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4852 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4853 # connections.
4854 backend dynamic
4855 fullconn 10000
4856 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4857 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4858
4859 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4860
4861
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004862grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004863 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004865 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004866 Arguments :
4867 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4868 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4869 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4870
4871 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4872 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004873 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004874 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4875
4876 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4877 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4878 simplify it.
4879
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004880
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004881hash-balance-factor <factor>
4882 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4884 yes | no | no | yes
4885 Arguments :
4886 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4887 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004888 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004889
4890 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4891 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4892 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4893 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4894 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4895 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4896 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4897
4898 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4899 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4900 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4901 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4902 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4903
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004904 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4905 consistent hashing mechanism.
4906
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004907 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4908
4909
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004910hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004911 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4913 yes | no | yes | yes
4914 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004915 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4916 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004917
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004918 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4919 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4920 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4921 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4922 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4923 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4924 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4925 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4926 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4927 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004928
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004929 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4930 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4931 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4932 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4933 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4934 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4935 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4936 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4937 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4938 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4939 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4940 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4941 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004942 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4943 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004944
4945 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4946
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004947 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004948 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4949 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4950 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004951 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4952 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4953 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004954
4955 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4956 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004957 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4958 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4959 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4960 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4961
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004962 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4963 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4964 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4965 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4966 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4967 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4968 parameter.
4969
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004970 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4971 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4972 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4973 used on strings.
4974
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004975 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4976
4977 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4978 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4979 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4980 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4981 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4982 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4983 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4984 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4985 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4986 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4987 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4988 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004989
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004990 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4991 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4992 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004993
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004994 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004995
4996
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004997http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4998 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4999 ones).
5000
5001 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5002 no | yes | yes | yes
5003
5004 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5005 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5006 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5007 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5008 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5009 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5010
5011 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5012 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5013 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5014
5015 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5016 below.
5017
5018 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5019 instance.
5020
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005021 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5022 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5023 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5024
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005025 Example:
5026 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5027 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5028 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5029
5030http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5031
5032 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5033 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5034 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5035 example, or to pass some internal information.
5036 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5037 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5038 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5039
5040http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5041
5042 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5043 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5044
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005045http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005046
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005047 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5048 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5049 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5050 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5051 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005052
5053http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5054 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5055
5056 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5057
5058 Example:
5059 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5060
5061 # applied to:
5062 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5063
5064 # outputs:
5065 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5066
5067 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5068
5069http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5070 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5071
5072 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5073
5074 Example:
5075 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5076
5077 # applied to:
5078 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5079
5080 # outputs:
5081 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5082
5083http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5084
5085 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5086 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5087 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5088
5089http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5090 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5091
5092 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5093 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5094 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5095 fallback.
5096
5097 Example:
5098 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5099 http-response set-status 431
5100 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5101 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5102
5103http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5104
5105 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5106 inline.
5107
5108 Arguments:
5109 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5110 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5111 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5112 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5113 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5114 (request and response)
5115 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5116 processing
5117 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5118 processing
5119 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5120 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5121 and '_'.
5122
5123 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5124 followed by some converters.
5125
5126 Example:
5127 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5128
5129http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5130
5131 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5132 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5133 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5134 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5135 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005136 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005137 processing.
5138
5139 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5140 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005141 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005142 rules evaluation.
5143
5144http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5145
5146 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5147 details about <var-name>.
5148
5149 Example:
5150 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5151
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005152
5153http-check comment <string>
5154 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5155 it fails.
5156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5157 yes | no | yes | yes
5158
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005159 Arguments :
5160 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5161 rule fails.
5162
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005163 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5164 user-friendly error reporting.
5165
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005166 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005167 "http-check expect".
5168
5169
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005170http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5171 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005172 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005173 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5175 yes | no | yes | yes
5176
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005177 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005178 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5179
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005180 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005181 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005182
5183 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5184 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5185 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5186 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5187
5188 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5189
5190 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5191
5192 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5193
5194 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5195
5196 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5197
5198 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5199 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5200 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5201 is used.
5202
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005203 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5204 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5205 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5206 haproxy -vv.
5207
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005208 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5209
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005210 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5211 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5212 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5213 different ports or with different servers.
5214
5215 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5216 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5217 the port with a "http-check connect".
5218
5219 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5220 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5221 do.
5222
5223 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5224 unset-var or comment rules.
5225
5226 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005227 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5228 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5229 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5230 option httpchk
5231
5232 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005233 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005234 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005235 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005236 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005237 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005238
5239 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5240
5241 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005242
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005243
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005244http-check disable-on-404
5245 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005247 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005248 Arguments : none
5249
5250 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5251 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5252 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5253 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5254 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5255 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5256 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5257 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005258 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5259 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005260 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5261 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5262 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005263
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005264 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005265
5266
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005267http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005268 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5269 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5270 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005271 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005273 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005274
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005275 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005276 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5277
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005278 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5279 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5280 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5281 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5282 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5283 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5284 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5285 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5286 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5287 result is always conclusive.
5288
5289 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5290 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5291 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005292 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5293 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005294 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5295 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005296 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5297 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5298 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005299
5300 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5301 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005302 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5303 supported :
5304 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5305 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005306 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5307 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5308 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5309 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5310 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005311
5312 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5313 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005314 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5315 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5316 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5317 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005318 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5319
5320 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5321 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5322 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5323 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5324
5325 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5326 informational message reported in logs if an error
5327 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5328 log-format string.
5329
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005330 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005331 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5332 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005333 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5334 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5335 details on the supported keywords.
5336
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005337 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5338 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5339 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5340 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005341
5342 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5343 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5344 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5345 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5346 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5347
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005348 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5349 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5350 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5351 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5352 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5353 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5354 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005355
5356 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005357 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005358 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5359 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5360 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5361 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5362
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005363 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5364 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005365 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5366 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5367 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5368 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5369 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5370 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5371 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5372 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005373 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5374 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5375 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5376 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5377 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5378 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5379 insensitive on the header names.
5380
5381 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5382 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5383 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5384 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5385 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5386 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005387
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005388 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005389 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005390 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5391 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5392 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5393 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5394 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005395 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005396 trace).
5397
5398 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005399 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005400 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5401 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5402 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5403 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5404 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005405 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005406
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005407 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5408 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5409 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5410 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5411 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5412 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5413
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005414 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005415 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005416 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5417 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5418 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5419 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5420 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5421 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5422
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005423 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5424 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5425 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5426 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5427 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005428
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005429 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5430 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5431
5432 Examples :
5433 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005434 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005435
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005436 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5437 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5438
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005439 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005440 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005441
5442 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005443 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005444
5445 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005446 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005447
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005448 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005449 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005450
5451
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005452http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005453 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5454 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005455 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5456 health checks.
5457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5458 yes | no | yes | yes
5459 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005460 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5461
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005462 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5463 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5464 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5465 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5466 to invent non-standard ones.
5467
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005468 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5469 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5470 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5471 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5472
5473 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5474 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5475 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5476 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005477
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005478 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005479 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005480 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005481 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5482 to add it.
5483
5484 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5485 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5486 to the log-format rules.
5487
5488 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5489 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5490 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005491
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005492 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5493 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5494 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5495 request.
5496
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005497 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5498 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5499 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005500 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5501 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5502 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5503 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005504 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005505
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005506 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005507 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5508 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005509
5510 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5511 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5512 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5513 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5514 configured request authority.
5515
5516 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5517 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005518
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005519 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005520
5521
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005522http-check send-state
5523 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5525 yes | no | yes | yes
5526 Arguments : none
5527
5528 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5529 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5530 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5531 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5532 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5533
5534 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5535 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5536 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5537 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5538 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005539 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5540 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5541 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5542
5543 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5544 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5545 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5546
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005547 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5548 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5549 checked in multiple backends.
5550
5551 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5552 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5553
5554 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5555 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5556 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5557 one fails.
5558
5559 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5560 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5561 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5562
5563 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5564 server's queue.
5565
5566 Example of a header received by the application server :
5567 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5568 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5569
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005570 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5571 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005572
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005573
5574http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005575 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005576 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5577 yes | no | yes | yes
5578
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005579 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005580 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5581 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5582 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5583 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5584 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5585 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5586 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5587 and '-'.
5588
5589 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5590
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005591 Examples :
5592 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005593
5594
5595http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005596 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005597 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5598 yes | no | yes | yes
5599
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005600 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005601 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5602 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5603 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5604 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5605 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5606 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5607 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5608 and '-'.
5609
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005610 Examples :
5611 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005613
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005614http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5615 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5616 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5617 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5618 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5620 yes | yes | yes | yes
5621 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005622 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005623 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005624 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005625 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005626
5627 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5628 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5629 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5630 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5631
5632 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5633 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5634 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5635 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5636
5637 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5638 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5639 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5640 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5641 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5642 chroot is performed.
5643
5644 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5645 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5646 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5647 considered.
5648
5649 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5650 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5651 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5652 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5653 considered as a raw string.
5654
5655 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5656 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5657 "content-type".
5658
5659 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5660 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5661 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5662 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5663 evaluated as a log-format string.
5664
5665 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5666 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5667 argument to "content-type".
5668
5669 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5670 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5671 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5672 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5673
5674 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5675 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5676 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5677 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5678 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5679 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5680 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5681 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5682
5683 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5684 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5685 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5686
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005687 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5688 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5689 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5690 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5691 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5692
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005693 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5694 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5695
5696
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005697http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005698 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5699
5700 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5701 no | yes | yes | yes
5702
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005703 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5704 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5705 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5706 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5707 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005708
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005709 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5710 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005711
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005712 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005713
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005714 Example:
5715 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5716 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5717 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005718
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005719 http-request allow if nagios
5720 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5721 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5722 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005723
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005724 Example:
5725 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5726 acl add path /addacl
5727 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005728
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005729 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005730
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005731 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5732 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005733
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005734 Example:
5735 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5736 acl setmap path /setmap
5737 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005738
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005739 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005740
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005741 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5742 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005743
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005744 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5745 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005746
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005747http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005748
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005749 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5750 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5751 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5752 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5753 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5754 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5755 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5756 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005757
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005758http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005759
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005760 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5761 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5762 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5763 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5764 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5765 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5766 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5767 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005769http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005770
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005771 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5772 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005773
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005774
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005775http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005776
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005777 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5778 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5779 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5780 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5781 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005782
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005783 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5784 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5785 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5786 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5787 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5788 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5789 instead.
5790
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005791 Example:
5792 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5793 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005794
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005795http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005796
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005797 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005798
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005799http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5800 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005801
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005802 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5803 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5804 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5805 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5806 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5807 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5808 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5809 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5810 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005811
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005812 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5813 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5814 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005815 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5816
5817 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5818 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5819 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5820 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005821
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005822http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005823
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005824 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5825 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5826 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5827 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5828 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5829 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005830
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005831http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005832
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005833 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5834 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5835 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5836 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5837 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005838
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005839http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005840
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005841 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5842 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5843 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5844 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5845 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5846 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005847
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005848http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5849http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5850 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5851 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5852 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5853 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005854
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005855 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5856 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5857 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005858 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005859 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5860 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5861 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005862 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005863 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005864
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005865http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5866 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5867 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5868 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5869
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005870http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5871
5872 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5873 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5874 pointed by <resolvers>.
5875 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5876 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5877 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5878 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5879 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5880 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5881 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5882 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5883 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5884 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5885 to 0.0.0.0.
5886
5887 Example:
5888 resolvers mydns
5889 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5890 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5891 timeout retry 1s
5892 hold valid 10s
5893 hold nx 3s
5894 hold other 3s
5895 hold obsolete 0s
5896 accepted_payload_size 8192
5897
5898 frontend fe
5899 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5900 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5901 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5902
5903 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5904 # which mean DNS resolution error
5905 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5906
5907 default_backend be
5908
5909 backend b_503
5910 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5911 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5912 # 503 error page to end users
5913
5914 backend be
5915 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5916 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5917 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5918 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5919 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5920
5921 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5922 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5923
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005924http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5925
5926 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5927 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5928 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5929 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005930 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5931 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005932
5933 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5934
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005935http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005936
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005937 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5938 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5939 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5940 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5941 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005942
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005943http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005944
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005945 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5946 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5947 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5948 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005949
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005950http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5951 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005952
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005953 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005954 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5955 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5956 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5957 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5958 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005959
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005960 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5961 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5962 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5963 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5964 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005965
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005966 Example:
5967 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5968
5969 # applied to:
5970 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5971
5972 # outputs:
5973 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5974
5975 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005976
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005977 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5978
5979 # applied to:
5980 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005981
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005982 # outputs:
5983 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005984
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005985http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5986 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5987
5988 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5989 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005990 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5991 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5992 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005993
5994 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5995 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5996 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5997
5998 Example:
5999 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6000 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6001
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006002 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6003 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6004 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6005 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6006
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006007http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6008 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6009
6010 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6011 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6012 query-string are replaced.
6013
6014 Example:
6015 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6016 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6017
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006018http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6019 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6020
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006021 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6022 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6023 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6024 against.
6025
6026 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6027 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6028 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006029
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006030 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6031 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6032 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6033 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6034 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6035 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6036 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6037 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6038 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006039 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6040 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006041
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006042 Example:
6043 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6044 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006045
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006046 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6047 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006048
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006049http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6050 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006051
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006052 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6053 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6054 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6055 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006056
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006057 Example:
6058 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006059
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006060 # applied to:
6061 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006062
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006063 # outputs:
6064 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006065
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006066http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6067 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6068 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006069 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006070 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6071
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006072 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006073 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6074 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006075 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006076 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006077 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006078 are followed to create the response :
6079
6080 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6081 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6082 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6083 ignored.
6084
6085 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6086 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006087 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006088 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6089 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006090
6091 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6092 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6093 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006094 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6095 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006096
6097 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6098 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6099 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006100 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006101 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006102 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006103
6104 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6105 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6106 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6107 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6108 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6109 as a raw content.
6110
6111 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6112 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6113 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6114 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6115 considered as a raw string.
6116
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006117 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006118 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6119 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6120 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6121
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006122 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6123 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006124 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006125
6126 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6127
6128 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006129 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006130 if { path /ping }
6131
6132 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6133 if { path /favicon.ico }
6134
6135 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6136 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6137 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6138
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006139http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6140http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006141
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006142 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6143 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6144 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006145
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006146http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6147 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006148
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006149 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6150 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6151 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6152 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006153
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006154http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006155
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006156 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6157 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6158 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6159 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6160 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006161
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006162 Arguments:
6163 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6164 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006165
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006166 Example:
6167 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6168 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006169
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006170 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6171 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006172
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006173http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006174
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006175 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6176 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6177 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006178
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006179 Arguments:
6180 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6181 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006182
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006183 Example:
6184 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6185 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006186
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006187 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6188 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6189 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006190
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006191http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006192
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006193 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6194 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6195 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6196 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6197 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006198
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006199 Example:
6200 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6201 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6202 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6203 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6204 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6205 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6206 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6207 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6208 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006209
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006210http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006211
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006212 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6213 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6214 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6215 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6216 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006217
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006218http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6219 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006220
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006221 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6222 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6223 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6224 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6225 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6226 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6227 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6228 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6229 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006230
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006231http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006232
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006233 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6234 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6235 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6236 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6237 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6238 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6239 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006240
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006241http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006242
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006243 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6244 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6245 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006246
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006247http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006248
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006249 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6250 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6251 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6252 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6253 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6254 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6255 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6256 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006257
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006258http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006259
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006260 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6261 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6262 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6263 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6264 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6265 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006266
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006267 Example :
6268 # prepend the host name before the path
6269 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006270
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006271http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6272
6273 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6274 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6275 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6276
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006277http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006278
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006279 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6280 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6281 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6282 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6283 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006284
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006285http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006286
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006287 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6288 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6289 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6290 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6291 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6292 values have higher priority.
6293 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6294 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6295 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6296 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6297 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006298
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006299http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006300
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006301 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6302 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6303 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6304 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6305 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6306 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6307 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006309 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006310
6311 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006312 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6313 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006314
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006315http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6316 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6317 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6318 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006319 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6320 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006321
6322 Arguments :
6323 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6324 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006325
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006326 See also "option forwardfor".
6327
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006328 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006329 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6330 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6331
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006332 # After the masking this will track connections
6333 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6334 http-request track-sc0 src
6335
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006336 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6337 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6338
6339http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6340
6341 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6342 expression.
6343
6344 Arguments:
6345 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6346 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006347
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006348 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006349 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6350 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6351
6352 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6353 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6354 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6355
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006356http-request set-timeout server|tunnel { <timeout> | <expr> }
6357 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6358
6359 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6360 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6361 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6362 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6363 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6364
6365 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6366 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6367 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6368 results.
6369
6370 Example:
6371 http-request set-timeout server 5s
6372 http-request set-timeout hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
6373
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006374http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6375
6376 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6377 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6378 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6379 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6380 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6381 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6382 information from the request.
6383
6384 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6385
6386http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6387
6388 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6389 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6390 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6391 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6392 path and the query string.
6393 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6394
6395http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6396
6397 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6398 inline.
6399
6400 Arguments:
6401 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6402 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6403 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6404 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6405 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6406 (request and response)
6407 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6408 processing
6409 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6410 processing
6411 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6412 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6413 and '_'.
6414
6415 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6416 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006417
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006418 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006419 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006420
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006421http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6422 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006423
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006424 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6425 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6426 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6427 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6428 agent name must be used.
6429
6430 Arguments:
6431 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6432
6433 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6434 configuration.
6435
6436http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6437
6438 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6439 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6440 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6441 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6442 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6443 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6444 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6445 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6446 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6447 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6448 action.
6449 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6450 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6451 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6452 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6453 you fully understand how it works.
6454
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006455http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6456
6457 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6458 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6459 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6460 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6461 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006462 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006463 processing.
6464
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006465 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006466 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6467 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6468 rules evaluation.
6469
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006470http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6471http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6472 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6473 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6474 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6475 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006476
6477 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6478 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6479 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006480 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6481 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6482 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6483 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6484 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6485 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6486 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6487 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6488 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6489 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006490 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006491 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6492 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6493 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6494 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6495 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006496
6497http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6498http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6499http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6500
6501 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6502 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6503 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6504 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006505 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006506 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6507 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6508 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6509 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6510 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6511 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6512 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6513
6514 Arguments :
6515 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6516 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6517 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6518 select which table entry to update the counters.
6519
6520 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6521 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6522 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6523 that table until the session ends.
6524
6525 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6526 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6527 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6528 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6529 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6530 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6531 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6532 useful information.
6533
6534 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6535 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6536 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6537 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6538 checks that make use of it.
6539
6540http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6541
6542 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006543
6544 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006545 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006546
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006547http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6548
6549 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6550 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6551 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6552 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6553 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6554 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6555
6556 Arguments :
6557 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6558
6559 Example:
6560 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6561
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006562http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006563
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006564 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6565 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6566 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006567
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006568
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006569http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006570 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6571
6572 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6573 no | yes | yes | yes
6574
6575 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6576 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6577 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6578 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6579 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6580 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6581
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006582 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6583 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006584
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006585 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006586
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006587 Example:
6588 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006589
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006590 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006591
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006592 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6593 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006594
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006595 Example:
6596 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006597
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006598 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006599
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006600 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6601 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006602
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006603 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6604 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006605
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006606http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006607
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006608 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6609 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6610 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6611 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6612 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6613 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6614 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6615 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006616
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006617http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006618
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006619 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6620 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6621 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6622 example, or to pass some internal information.
6623 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6624 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6625 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006626
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006627http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006628
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006629 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6630 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006631
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006632http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006633
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006634 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006635
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006636http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006637
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006638 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6639 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6640 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6641 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6642 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6643 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6644 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006645
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006646 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6647 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6648 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6649 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6650 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006651
6652 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6653 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6654 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6655 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006656
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006657http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006658
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006659 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6660 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6661 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6662 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6663 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6664 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006665
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006666http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006667
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006668 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6669 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6670 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6671 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6672 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006673
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006674http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006675
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006676 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6677 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6678 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6679 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6680 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6681 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006682
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006683http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6684http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6685 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6686 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6687 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6688 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006689
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006690 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6691 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6692 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006693 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006694 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6695 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6696 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006697 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006698 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006699
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006700http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006701
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006702 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6703 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6704 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6705 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6706 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6707 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006708
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006709http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6710 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006711
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006712 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6713 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006714
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006715 Example:
6716 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006717
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006718 # applied to:
6719 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006720
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006721 # outputs:
6722 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006723
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006724 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006725
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006726http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6727 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006728
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006729 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006730 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006731
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006732 Example:
6733 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006734
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006735 # applied to:
6736 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006737
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006738 # outputs:
6739 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006740
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006741http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6742 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6743 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006744 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006745 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6746
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006747 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006748 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6749 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006750 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006751 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006752 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006753 are followed to create the response :
6754
6755 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6756 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6757 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6758 ignored.
6759
6760 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6761 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006762 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006763 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6764 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006765
6766 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6767 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6768 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006769 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6770 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006771
6772 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6773 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6774 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006775 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006776 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006777 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006778
6779 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6780 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6781 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6782 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6783 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6784 as a raw content.
6785
6786 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6787 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6788 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6789 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6790 considered as a raw string.
6791
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006792 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6793 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6794 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6795 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6796
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006797 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6798 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006799 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006800
6801 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6802
6803 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006804 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006805 if { status eq 404 }
6806
6807 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6808 string "This is the end !" \
6809 if { status eq 500 }
6810
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006811http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6812http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006813
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006814 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6815 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6816 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006817
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006818http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6819 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006820
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006821 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6822 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6823 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6824 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006825
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006826http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006827
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006828 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6829 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6830 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6831 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6832 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006833
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006834 Arguments:
6835 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006836
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006837 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6838 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006839
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006840http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006841
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006842 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6843 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6844 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006845
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006846http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6847
6848 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6849 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6850 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6851 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6852 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6853
6854http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6855
6856 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6857 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6858 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6859 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6860 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6861 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6862 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6863 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6864 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6865
6866http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6867
6868 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6869 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6870 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6871 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6872 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6873 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6874 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6875
6876http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6877
6878 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6879 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6880 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6881 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6882 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6883 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6884 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6885 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6886
6887http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6888 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6889
6890 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6891 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6892 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6893 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006894
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006895 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006896 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6897 http-response set-status 431
6898 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6899 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006900
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006901http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006902
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006903 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6904 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6905 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6906 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6907 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6908 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6909 based on some information from the request.
6910
6911 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6912
6913http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6914
6915 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6916 inline.
6917
6918 Arguments:
6919 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6920 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6921 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6922 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6923 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6924 (request and response)
6925 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6926 processing
6927 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6928 processing
6929 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6930 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6931 and '_'.
6932
6933 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6934 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006935
6936 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006937 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006938
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006939http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006940
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006941 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6942 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6943 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6944 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6945 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6946 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6947 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6948 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6949 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6950 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6951 action.
6952 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6953 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6954 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6955 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6956 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006957
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006958http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6959
6960 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6961 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6962 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6963 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6964 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006965 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006966 processing.
6967
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006968 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006969 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006970 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006971 rules evaluation.
6972
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006973http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6974http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6975http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006976
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006977 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6978 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6979 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6980 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6981 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6982 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6983
6984http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6985
6986 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6987 about <var-name>.
6988
6989 Example:
6990 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6991
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006992
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006993http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6994 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6995
6996 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6997 yes | no | yes | yes
6998
6999 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007000 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7001 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7002 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007003
7004 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7005
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007006 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7007 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7008 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7009 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7010 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7011 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7012 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
7013 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
7014 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7015 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007016
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007017 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7018 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7019 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7020 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7021 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7022 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7023 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007024 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7025 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7026 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7027 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7028 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7029 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007030
7031 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7032 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7033 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7034 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7035 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7036 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7037 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7038 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007039 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007040 downsides of rare connection failures.
7041
7042 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7043 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7044 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7045 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7046 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7047 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007048 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007049 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7050 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7051 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7052 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7053 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7054
7055 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007056 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7057 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7058 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7059 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007060
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007061 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7062 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007063
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007064 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007065
7066 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7067 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7068 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7069
7070 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7071
7072
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007073http-send-name-header [<header>]
7074 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007075 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7076 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007077 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007078 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7079
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007080 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7081 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7082 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7083 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7084 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7085 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7086 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7087 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7088 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7089 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7090 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7091 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7092 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7093 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7094 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7095 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007096
7097 See also : "server"
7098
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007099id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007100 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7102 no | yes | yes | yes
7103 Arguments : none
7104
7105 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7106 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7107 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007108
7109
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007110ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7111 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7112 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007113 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007114
7115 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7116 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7117 and running).
7118
7119 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7120 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7121 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007122 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007123 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7124
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007125 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7126 "unless" condition is met.
7127
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007128 Example:
7129 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7130 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7131 ignore-persist if url_static
7132
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007133 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7134
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007135load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7136 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7137 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7138 yes | no | yes | yes
7139
7140 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7141 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7142 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007143 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007144 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7145 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7146 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7147 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7148
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007149 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007150 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007151 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007152
7153 Arguments:
7154 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7155 named "server-state-file".
7156
7157 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7158 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7159 name is used as a file name.
7160
7161 none don't load any stat for this backend
7162
7163 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007164 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7165 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7166 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007167 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007168 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007169
7170 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7171 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7172
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007173 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007174
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007175 global
7176 stats socket /tmp/socket
7177 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007178
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007179 defaults
7180 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007181
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007182 backend bk
7183 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7184 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007185
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007186
7187 Then one can run :
7188
7189 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7190
7191 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7192
7193 1
7194 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7195 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7196 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7197
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007198 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007199
7200 global
7201 stats socket /tmp/socket
7202 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7203
7204 defaults
7205 load-server-state-from-file local
7206
7207 backend bk
7208 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7209 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7210
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007211
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007212 Then one can run :
7213
7214 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7215
7216 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7217
7218 1
7219 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7220 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7221 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7222
7223 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7224 "show servers state"
7225
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007226
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007227log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007228log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007229 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007230no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007231 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7233 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007234
7235 Prefix :
7236 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7237 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7238 prefix does not allow arguments.
7239
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007240 Arguments :
7241 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7242 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7243 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7244 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7245 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7246 parameter.
7247
7248 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7249 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7250
7251 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7252 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7253 standard syslog port).
7254
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007255 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7256 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7257 standard syslog port).
7258
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007259 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7260 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7261 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007262 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007263
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007264 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7265 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7266 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7267 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7268 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7269 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7270 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7271 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7272 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7273 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7274 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7275 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7276 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7277 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7278 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7279 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007280 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7281 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007282
7283 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7284 and "fd@2", see above.
7285
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007286 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7287 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7288 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7289 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7290 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7291 having the logs instantly available.
7292
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007293 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7294 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007295
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007296 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7297 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7298 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7299 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7300 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7301 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7302 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7303 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7304 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7305 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007306 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007307
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007308 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7309 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7310 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7311 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7312 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7313
7314 <sample_size>
7315 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7316 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7317 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7318 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7319 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7320
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007321 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7322 one of the following :
7323
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007324 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7325 field is stripped. This is the default.
7326 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7327 rfc3164.
7328
7329 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007330 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7331
7332 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7333 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7334
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007335 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7336 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7337 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7338 designed to be used with a local log server.
7339
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007340 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7341 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7342 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7343 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7344 systemd logger consumes.
7345
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007346 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7347 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7348 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7349 used with a local log server.
7350
7351 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7352 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7353 designed to be used with a local log server.
7354
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007355 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7356 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7357 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7358 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7359
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007360 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7361
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007362 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7363 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7364 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7365
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007366 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7367 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7368 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7369 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007370
7371 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7372 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7373 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007374 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7375 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7376 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7377 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7378 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007379
7380 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7381
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007382 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7383 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7384 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007385
7386 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7387 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7388 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7389 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7390
7391 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7392 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007393
7394 Example :
7395 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007396 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7397 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7398 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007399 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
7400 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007401 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007402
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007403
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007404log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007405 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7406 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7407 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007408
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007409 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7410 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7411 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7412 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7413 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007414
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007415 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7416 "option httplog" directives.
7417
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007418log-format-sd <string>
7419 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7420 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7421 yes | yes | yes | no
7422
7423 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7424 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7425 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7426 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7427 which covers the log format string in depth.
7428
7429 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7430 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7431
7432 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7433 log format to "rfc5424".
7434
7435 Example :
7436 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7437
7438
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007439log-tag <string>
7440 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7441 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7442 yes | yes | yes | yes
7443
7444 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7445 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7446 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7447 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7448 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7449 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7450 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7451 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7452 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007453
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007454max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7455 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7456 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7457 yes | no | yes | yes
7458
7459 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7460 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7461 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7462 servers.
7463
7464 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7465 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7466 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7467 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7468 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007469 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007470 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7471 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7472 picking a different server.
7473
7474 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7475 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7476 even if they have to be queued.
7477
7478 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7479 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7480
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007481max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7482 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7483 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7484 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007485
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007486maxconn <conns>
7487 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7489 yes | yes | yes | no
7490 Arguments :
7491 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7492 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7493 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7494 closes.
7495
7496 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7497 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7498 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7499 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007500 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7501 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7502 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7503 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007504
7505 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7506 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7507 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7508
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007509 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7510 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007511
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007512 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7513
7514
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007515mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007516 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7518 yes | yes | yes | yes
7519 Arguments :
7520 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7521 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7522 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7523 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7524
7525 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7526 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7527 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7528 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7529 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7530
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007531 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7532 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7533 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007534
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007535 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007536 defaults http_instances
7537 mode http
7538
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007539
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007540monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007541 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7543 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007544 Arguments :
7545 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7546 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007547 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007548 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7549 backend and its backup.
7550
7551 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7552 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7553 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7554 servers in a list of backends.
7555
7556 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7557 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7558 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7559 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7560 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7561 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7562 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007563 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7564 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007565
7566 Example:
7567 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007568 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007569 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7570 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7571 monitor-uri /site_alive
7572 monitor fail if site_dead
7573
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007574 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007575
7576
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007577monitor-uri <uri>
7578 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7580 yes | yes | yes | no
7581 Arguments :
7582 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7583 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7584
7585 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7586 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7587 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7588 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7589 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7590 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7591 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7592 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7593
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007594 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007595 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7596 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7597 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7598 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7599 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7600 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007601
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007602 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7603 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7604 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7605 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7606
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007607 Example :
7608 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7609 frontend www
7610 mode http
7611 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7612
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007613 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007614
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007615
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007616option abortonclose
7617no option abortonclose
7618 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7620 yes | no | yes | yes
7621 Arguments : none
7622
7623 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7624 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7625 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7626 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007627 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007628 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7629 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7630 encountered while delivering the response.
7631
7632 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7633 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7634 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7635 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7636 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7637 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007638 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007639 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007640 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007641 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7642 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7643 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7644
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007645 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7646 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007647 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7648 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7649 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7650 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7651 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7652 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007653 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007654
7655 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7656 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7657
7658 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7659
7660
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007661option accept-invalid-http-request
7662no option accept-invalid-http-request
7663 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7665 yes | yes | yes | no
7666 Arguments : none
7667
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007668 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007669 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007670 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007671 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7672 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7673 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7674 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7675 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007676 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7677 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7678 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7679 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007680 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007681 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007682 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7683 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7684 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007685
7686 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7687 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7688 been confirmed.
7689
7690 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7691 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007692 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7693 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007694 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7695
7696 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7697 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7698
7699 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7700 stats socket.
7701
7702
7703option accept-invalid-http-response
7704no option accept-invalid-http-response
7705 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7707 yes | no | yes | yes
7708 Arguments : none
7709
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007710 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007711 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007712 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007713 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7714 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7715 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7716 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7717 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007718 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7719 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7720 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007721
7722 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7723 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7724 been confirmed.
7725
7726 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7727 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7728 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7729 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7730
7731 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7732 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7733
7734 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7735 stats socket.
7736
7737
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007738option allbackups
7739no option allbackups
7740 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7742 yes | no | yes | yes
7743 Arguments : none
7744
7745 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7746 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7747 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7748 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7749 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7750 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7751 order between the backup servers anymore.
7752
7753 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7754 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7755
7756 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7757 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7758
7759
7760option checkcache
7761no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007762 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7764 yes | no | yes | yes
7765 Arguments : none
7766
7767 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7768 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007769 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007770 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7771 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007772 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007773
7774 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007775 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007776 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007777 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7778 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007779 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007780 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007781 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7782 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007783 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007784 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7785 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007786 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007787 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7788 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7789 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7790 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7791 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7792 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7793 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7794 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7795 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7796
7797 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007798 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7799 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7800 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7801 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007802
7803 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7804 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007805 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007806 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007807
7808 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7809 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7810
7811
7812option clitcpka
7813no option clitcpka
7814 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7816 yes | yes | yes | no
7817 Arguments : none
7818
7819 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7820 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007821 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007822 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7823
7824 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7825 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7826 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7827 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7828
7829 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7830 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7831 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7832 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7833 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7834
7835 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7836
7837 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7838 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7839 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7840
7841 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7842 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7843
7844 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7845
7846
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007847option contstats
7848 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7850 yes | yes | yes | no
7851 Arguments : none
7852
7853 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7854 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7855 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7856 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007857 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7858 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7859 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7860 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7861 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007862
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007863option disable-h2-upgrade
7864no option disable-h2-upgrade
7865 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7866 connection.
7867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7868 yes | yes | yes | no
7869 Arguments : none
7870
7871 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7872 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7873 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7874 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7875 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7876 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7877 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7878 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7879
7880 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7881 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007882
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007883option dontlog-normal
7884no option dontlog-normal
7885 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7887 yes | yes | yes | no
7888 Arguments : none
7889
7890 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7891 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7892 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7893 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7894 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7895 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7896 logged.
7897
7898 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7899 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7900 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7901
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007902 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007903 logging.
7904
7905
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007906option dontlognull
7907no option dontlognull
7908 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7910 yes | yes | yes | no
7911 Arguments : none
7912
7913 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7914 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7915 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7916 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7917 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7918 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007919 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7920 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7921 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007922
7923 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007924 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007925 would not be logged.
7926
7927 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7928 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7929
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007930 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007931 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007932
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007933
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007934option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007935 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7937 yes | yes | yes | yes
7938 Arguments :
7939 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7940 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007941 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007942 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007943
7944 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7945 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7946 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7947 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7948 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7949 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7950 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007951 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7952 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7953 possible that the client has already brought one.
7954
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007955 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007956 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007957 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007958 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007959 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007960 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007961
7962 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7963 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7964 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7965 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7966 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7967 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7968 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7969
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007970 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7971 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7972 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7973 are under the control of the end-user.
7974
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007975 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007976 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7977 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007978 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7979 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7980 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007981
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007982 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007983 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7984 frontend www
7985 mode http
7986 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7987
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007988 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7989 backend www
7990 mode http
7991 option forwardfor header X-Client
7992
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007993 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007994 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007995
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007996
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007997option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7998no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7999 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8001 yes | yes | yes | no
8002 Arguments : none
8003
8004 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8005 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8006 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8007 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8008 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8009 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8010 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8011
8012 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8013 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8014 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8015 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8016 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8017 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8018 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8019 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8020 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8021 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8022
8023 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8024
8025 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8026 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8027
8028 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8029 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8030
8031
8032option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8033no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8034 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8036 yes | no | yes | yes
8037 Arguments : none
8038
8039 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8040 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8041 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8042 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8043 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8044 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8045 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8046
8047 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8048 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8049 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8050 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8051 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8052 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8053 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8054 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8055 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8056 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8057
8058 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8059
8060 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8061 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8062
8063 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8064 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8065
8066
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008067option http-buffer-request
8068no option http-buffer-request
8069 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8071 yes | yes | yes | yes
8072 Arguments : none
8073
8074 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8075 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8076 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8077 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8078 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8079 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008080 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8081 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8082 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8083 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008084
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01008085 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008086
8087
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008088option http-ignore-probes
8089no option http-ignore-probes
8090 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8092 yes | yes | yes | no
8093 Arguments : none
8094
8095 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8096 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8097 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8098 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8099 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8100 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8101 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8102 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8103 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008104 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8105 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008106 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8107
8108 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8109 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8110 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8111 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8112 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8113 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8114 are often the only way to detect them.
8115
8116 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8117 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8118
8119 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8120
8121
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008122option http-keep-alive
8123no option http-keep-alive
8124 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8126 yes | yes | yes | yes
8127 Arguments : none
8128
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008129 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8130 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008131 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8132 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008133 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8134 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8135 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008136
8137 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8138 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008139 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8140 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8141 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8142 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8143 situations where this option may be useful :
8144
8145 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008146 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008147
8148 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8149 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8150
8151 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8152 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8153 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8154 request.
8155
8156 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8157 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008158 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8159 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8160 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008161
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008162 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8163 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8164 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8165 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8166 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8167 not set.
8168
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008169 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8170 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8171 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008172
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008173 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008174 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008175 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008176
8177
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008178option http-no-delay
8179no option http-no-delay
8180 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8182 yes | yes | yes | yes
8183 Arguments : none
8184
8185 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8186 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8187 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8188 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8189 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8190 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8191 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8192 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8193 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8194 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8195 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8196 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8197 affected.
8198
8199 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8200 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8201 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8202 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8203 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8204 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8205 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8206 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8207 latency environments.
8208
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008209 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8210
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008211
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008212option http-pretend-keepalive
8213no option http-pretend-keepalive
8214 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008216 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008217 Arguments : none
8218
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008219 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008220 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8221 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8222 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8223 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8224 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8225 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8226 consider the response complete.
8227
8228 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8229 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8230 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8231 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008232 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008233 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8234
8235 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8236 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8237 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8238 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8239 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8240 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8241 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8242
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008243 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8244 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8245 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8246 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8247 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8248 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008249
8250 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8251 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8252
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008253 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008254 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008255
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008256
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008257option http-server-close
8258no option http-server-close
8259 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8261 yes | yes | yes | yes
8262 Arguments : none
8263
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008264 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8265 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8266 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8267 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008268 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8269 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8270 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8271 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8272 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8273 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8274 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8275 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8276 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8277 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8278 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008279
8280 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8281 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8282 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8283 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008284 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8285 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008286
8287 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8288 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008289 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8290 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8291 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008292
8293 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8294 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8295
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008296 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8297 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008298
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008299option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008300no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008301 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8303 yes | yes | yes | no
8304 Arguments : none
8305
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008306 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008307 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8308 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8309 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8310 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8311 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8312 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8313
8314 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8315 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008316 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8317 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8318 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008319
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008320 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8321 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8322 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8323 front of an existing proxy.
8324
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008325 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8326
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008327 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008328
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008329option httpchk
8330option httpchk <uri>
8331option httpchk <method> <uri>
8332option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008333 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8335 yes | no | yes | yes
8336 Arguments :
8337 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8338 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8339 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8340 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8341 ones.
8342
8343 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8344 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8345 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8346
8347 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8348 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8349 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008350 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008351
8352 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8353 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8354 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8355 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8356 the lack of any response.
8357
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008358 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8359 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8360 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8361 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8362
8363 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8364 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8365 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008366
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008367 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8368 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008369 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008370 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008371 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008372
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008373 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8374 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8375 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8376 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8377
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008378 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008379 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8380 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8381 backend https_relay
8382 mode tcp
8383 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8384 http-check send hdr Host www
8385 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008386
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008387 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8388 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8389 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008390
8391
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008392option httpclose
8393no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008394 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8396 yes | yes | yes | yes
8397 Arguments : none
8398
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008399 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8400 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8401 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8402 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008403 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008404
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008405 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8406 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008407 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008408 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8409 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008410
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008411 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8412 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8413 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008414
8415 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8416 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008417 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8418 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8419 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008420
8421 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8422 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8423
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008424 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008425
8426
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008427option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008428 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008430 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008431 Arguments :
8432 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8433 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8434 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008435 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008436 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008437
8438 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8439 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8440 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8441 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8442 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8443 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8444 ports.
8445
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008446 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8447 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008448
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008449 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8450
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008451 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008452
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008453
8454option http_proxy
8455no option http_proxy
8456 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8458 yes | yes | yes | yes
8459 Arguments : none
8460
8461 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8462 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8463 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8464 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8465 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8466
8467 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8468 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008469 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8470 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008471
8472 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8473 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8474
8475 Example :
8476 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8477 backend direct_forward
8478 option httpclose
8479 option http_proxy
8480
8481 See also : "option httpclose"
8482
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008483
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008484option independent-streams
8485no option independent-streams
8486 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8488 yes | yes | yes | yes
8489 Arguments : none
8490
8491 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8492 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8493 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8494 receive data or not.
8495
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008496 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008497 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8498 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8499 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8500 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8501 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8502 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8503 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8504 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8505 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8506 socket buffers.
8507
8508 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8509 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8510 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8511 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8512 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8513
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008514 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008515
8516
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008517option ldap-check
8518 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8520 yes | no | yes | yes
8521 Arguments : none
8522
8523 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8524 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8525 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8526 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8527
8528 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8529 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8530
8531 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8532 configure it.
8533
8534 Example :
8535 option ldap-check
8536
8537 See also : "option httpchk"
8538
8539
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008540option external-check
8541 Use external processes for server health checks
8542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8543 yes | no | yes | yes
8544
8545 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8546 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8547 command".
8548
8549 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8550
8551 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8552
8553
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008554option log-health-checks
8555no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008556 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8558 yes | no | yes | yes
8559 Arguments : none
8560
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008561 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8562 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8563 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008564
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008565 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8566 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8567 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8568 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8569 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8570
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008571 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008572 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008573
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008574 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8575 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8576 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008577
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008578
8579option log-separate-errors
8580no option log-separate-errors
8581 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8583 yes | yes | yes | no
8584 Arguments : none
8585
8586 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8587 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8588 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8589 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8590 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8591 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8592 provides very important information.
8593
8594 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8595 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8596 error logs.
8597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008598 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008599 logging.
8600
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008601
8602option logasap
8603no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008604 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8606 yes | yes | yes | no
8607 Arguments : none
8608
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008609 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8610 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8611 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8612 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8613
8614 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8615 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8616 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8617 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8618 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008619 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008620 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8621 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8622 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8623 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008624 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008625
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008626 Examples :
8627 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8628 mode http
8629 option httplog
8630 option logasap
8631 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8632
8633 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8634 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8635 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8636 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8637
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008638 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008639 logging.
8640
8641
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008642option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008643 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8645 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008646 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008647 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8648 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008649 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8650 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008651
8652 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8653 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008654 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008655 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8656 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8657 in the MySQL table, like this :
8658
8659 USE mysql;
8660 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8661 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8662
8663 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008664 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008665 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8666 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8667 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8668 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8669 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8670 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8671 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8672
8673 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8674 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008675
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008676 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008677
8678 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8679 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8680 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8681 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008682 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8683 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008684
8685 See also: "option httpchk"
8686
8687
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008688option nolinger
8689no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008690 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008691 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8692 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008693 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008694
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008695 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008696 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8697 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8698 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8699 connections.
8700
8701 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8702 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008703 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8704 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8705 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8706 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8707 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8708 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8709 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8710 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8711 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8712 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8713 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8714 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8715 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008716
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008717 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8718 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8719 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8720 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8721 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008722
8723 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8724 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008725 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05008726 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008727 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008728
8729 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8730 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8731
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008732 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8733 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008734
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008735option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8736 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8738 yes | yes | yes | yes
8739 Arguments :
8740 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8741 matching <network>
8742 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8743 header name.
8744
8745 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8746 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8747 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8748 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8749 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8750 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8751 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8752 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8753 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8754 possible that the client has already brought one.
8755
8756 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8757 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8758 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8759 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8760 header and requires different one.
8761
8762 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8763 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8764 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8765 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8766 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8767 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8768 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8769
8770 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8771 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8772 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8773 both are defined.
8774
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008775 Examples :
8776 # Original Destination address
8777 frontend www
8778 mode http
8779 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8780
8781 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8782 backend www
8783 mode http
8784 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8785
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008786 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008787
8788
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008789option persist
8790no option persist
8791 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8792 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8793 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008794 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008795
8796 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8797 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8798 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8799 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8800 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8801 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8802 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8803 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8804 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8805 redirected to another valid server.
8806
8807 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8808 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8809
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008810 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008811
8812
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008813option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8814 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8816 yes | no | yes | yes
8817 Arguments :
8818 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8819 PostgreSQL server.
8820
8821 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8822 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8823 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8824 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8825
8826 See also: "option httpchk"
8827
8828
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008829option prefer-last-server
8830no option prefer-last-server
8831 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8832 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8833 yes | no | yes | yes
8834 Arguments : none
8835
8836 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8837 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8838 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8839 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8840 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8841 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8842 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8843 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8844 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008845 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8846 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008847 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8848 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8849 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008850 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8851 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8852 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008853
8854 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8855 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8856
8857 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8858
8859
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008860option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008861option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008862no option redispatch
8863 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8864 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8865 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008866 Arguments :
8867 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8868 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8869 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008870 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008871 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008872 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008873 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8874 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8875 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8876
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008877
8878 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8879 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8880 be able to access the service anymore.
8881
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008882 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8883 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008884
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008885 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8886 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8887 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8888 following order:
8889
8890 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8891
8892 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8893 list, or
8894
8895 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8896
8897 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8898 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8899
8900 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8901 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8902 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8903 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8904
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008905 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008906 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8907 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008908
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008909 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8910 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8911
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008912 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008913
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008914
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008915option redis-check
8916 Use redis health checks for server testing
8917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8918 yes | no | yes | yes
8919 Arguments : none
8920
8921 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8922 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8923 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8924 find the "+PONG" response message.
8925
8926 Example :
8927 option redis-check
8928
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008929 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008930
8931
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008932option smtpchk
8933option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8934 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8936 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008937 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008938 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008939 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008940 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8941
8942 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8943 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8944 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8945
8946 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8947 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8948 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8949 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8950 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8951 dead server.
8952
8953 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8954 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008955 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008956 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8957
8958 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8959 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8960 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8961 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008962 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008963
8964 Example :
8965 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8966
8967 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8968
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008969
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008970option socket-stats
8971no option socket-stats
8972
8973 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8975 yes | yes | yes | no
8976
8977 Arguments : none
8978
8979
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008980option splice-auto
8981no option splice-auto
8982 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8984 yes | yes | yes | yes
8985 Arguments : none
8986
8987 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8988 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008989 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008990 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008991 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008992 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8993 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8994 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8995 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8996
8997 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8998 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8999 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9000 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9001 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9002 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9003 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9004 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9005 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9006 keyword.
9007
9008 Example :
9009 option splice-auto
9010
9011 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9012 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9013
9014 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9015 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9016
9017
9018option splice-request
9019no option splice-request
9020 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9022 yes | yes | yes | yes
9023 Arguments : none
9024
9025 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009026 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009027 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9028 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9029 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9030 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9031
9032 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9033
9034 Example :
9035 option splice-request
9036
9037 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9038 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9039
9040 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9041 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9042
9043
9044option splice-response
9045no option splice-response
9046 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9048 yes | yes | yes | yes
9049 Arguments : none
9050
9051 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009052 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009053 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9054 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9055 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9056 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9057
9058 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9059
9060 Example :
9061 option splice-response
9062
9063 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9064 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9065
9066 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9067 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9068
9069
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009070option spop-check
9071 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9073 no | no | no | yes
9074 Arguments : none
9075
9076 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9077 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9078 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9079 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9080
9081 Example :
9082 option spop-check
9083
9084 See also : "option httpchk"
9085
9086
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009087option srvtcpka
9088no option srvtcpka
9089 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9091 yes | no | yes | yes
9092 Arguments : none
9093
9094 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9095 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009096 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009097 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9098
9099 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9100 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9101 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9102 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9103
9104 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9105 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9106 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9107 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9108 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9109
9110 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9111
9112 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9113 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9114 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9115
9116 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9117 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9118
9119 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9120
9121
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009122option ssl-hello-chk
9123 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9125 yes | no | yes | yes
9126 Arguments : none
9127
9128 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9129 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9130 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9131 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9132 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9133 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9134 hello message.
9135
9136 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9137 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9138 messages, which is appreciable.
9139
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009140 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9141 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9142 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009143
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009144 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9145
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009146
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009147option tcp-check
9148 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9149 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9150 yes | no | yes | yes
9151
9152 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9153 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9154
9155 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9156 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9157 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9158
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009159 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009160 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9161 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9162 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9163 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9164 only.
9165
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009166 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009167 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9168 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9169 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9170 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9171
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009172 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009173 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9174 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009175 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009176 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9177 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9178 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9179 the respective protocols.
9180 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009181 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009182
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009183 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009184
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009185 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9186 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9187 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9188 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009189
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009190 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9191 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9192 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009193
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009194
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009195 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009196 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009197 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009198 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009199
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009200 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009201 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009202 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009203
9204 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9205 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009206 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009207 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009208 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009209 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009210 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009211 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009212 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9213 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009214 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009215 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9216 tcp-check expect string +OK
9217
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009218 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009219 (send many headers before analyzing)
9220 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009221 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009222 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9223 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9224 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9225 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009226 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009227
9228
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009229 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009230
9231
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009232option tcp-smart-accept
9233no option tcp-smart-accept
9234 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9236 yes | yes | yes | no
9237 Arguments : none
9238
9239 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9240 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9241 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9242 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9243 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9244 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9245
9246 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9247 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9248 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9249 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9250
9251 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9252 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9253 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009254 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009255
9256 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9257 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9258 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9259
9260 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9261 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9262 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9263
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009264 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9265
9266
9267option tcp-smart-connect
9268no option tcp-smart-connect
9269 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9271 yes | no | yes | yes
9272 Arguments : none
9273
9274 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9275 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9276 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9277 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9278 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9279
9280 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9281 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9282 complex.
9283
9284 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9285 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9286 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9287
9288 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9289 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9290
9291 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9292
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009293
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009294option tcpka
9295 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9297 yes | yes | yes | yes
9298 Arguments : none
9299
9300 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9301 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009302 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009303 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9304
9305 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9306 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9307 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9308 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9309
9310 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9311 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9312 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9313 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9314 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9315
9316 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9317
9318 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9319 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9320 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9321 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9322 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9323 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9324 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9325 backends.
9326
9327 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9328
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009329
9330option tcplog
9331 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009333 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009334 Arguments : none
9335
9336 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9337 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9338 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9339 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9340 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9341 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9342 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9343 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9344
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009345 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9346
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009347 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009348
9349
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009350option transparent
9351no option transparent
9352 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009354 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009355 Arguments : none
9356
9357 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9358 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9359 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9360 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9361 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9362 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9363 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9364 appropriate server.
9365
9366 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9367 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9368
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009369 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009370 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009371
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009372
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009373external-check command <command>
9374 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9376 yes | no | yes | yes
9377
9378 Arguments :
9379 <command> is the external command to run
9380
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009381 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9382
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009383 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009384
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009385 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9386 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9387 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9388 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9389 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9390 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009391
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009392 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9393
9394 Environment variables :
9395 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9396 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9397
9398 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9399
9400 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9401
9402 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9403 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9404 for a UNIX socket).
9405
9406 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9407
9408 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9409
9410 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9411
9412 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9413
9414 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9415
9416 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9417 socket).
9418
9419 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9420 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9421
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009422 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9423
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009424 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9425 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9426 failed.
9427
9428 Example :
9429 external-check command /bin/true
9430
9431 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9432
9433
9434external-check path <path>
9435 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9437 yes | no | yes | yes
9438
9439 Arguments :
9440 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9441
9442 The default path is "".
9443
9444 Example :
9445 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9446
9447 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9448 "external-check command"
9449
9450
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009451persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009452persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009453 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9455 yes | no | yes | yes
9456 Arguments :
9457 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009458 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9459 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009460
9461 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9462 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009463 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009464 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9465 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9466 forwarded to this server.
9467
9468 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9469 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9470 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009471 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009472 a single "listen" section.
9473
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009474 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9475 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9476 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9477
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009478 Example :
9479 listen tse-farm
9480 bind :3389
9481 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9482 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9483 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9484 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9485 persist rdp-cookie
9486 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009487 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009488 balance rdp-cookie
9489 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9490 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9491
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009492 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9493 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009494
9495
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009496rate-limit sessions <rate>
9497 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9499 yes | yes | yes | no
9500 Arguments :
9501 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9502 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9503
9504 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9505 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9506 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9507 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9508 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9509 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9510
9511 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9512 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9513 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9514 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9515
9516 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9517 listen smtp
9518 mode tcp
9519 bind :25
9520 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009521 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009522
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009523 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9524 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9525 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009526
9527 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9528
9529
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009530redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9531redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9532redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009533 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9535 no | yes | yes | yes
9536
9537 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009538 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009539
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009540 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009541 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009542 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9543 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9544 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009545
9546 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9547 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9548 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9549 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9550 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009551 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9552 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9553 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9554 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009555
9556 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9557 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9558 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9559 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9560 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9561 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009562 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009563 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009564 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9565 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9566 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009567
9568 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009569 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9570 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9571 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009572 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009573 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9574 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9575 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9576 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009577
9578 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009579 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009580
9581 - "drop-query"
9582 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9583 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9584 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9585 with a location-type redirect.
9586
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009587 - "append-slash"
9588 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9589 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9590 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9591 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9592
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009593 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9594 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9595 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9596 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9597 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9598 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9599 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9600
9601 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9602 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9603 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9604 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9605 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9606 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9607 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009608
9609 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9610 acl clear dst_port 80
9611 acl secure dst_port 8080
9612 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009613 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009614 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009615 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9616
9617 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009618 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9619 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9620 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009621 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009622
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009623 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9624 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9625 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9626
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009627 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009628 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009629
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009630 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009631 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9632 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9633 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009634
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009635 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009636
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009637
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009638retries <value>
9639 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9640 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9641 yes | no | yes | yes
9642 Arguments :
9643 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9644 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9645 default value is 3.
9646
9647 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9648 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9649 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9650
9651 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009652 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9653 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009654
9655 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9656 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9657
9658 See also : "option redispatch"
9659
9660
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009661retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009662 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9663 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9664 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009665 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9666 yes | no | yes | yes
9667 Arguments :
9668 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9669 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9670 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9671 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9672
9673 none never retry
9674
9675 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9676 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9677
9678 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9679 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9680 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9681 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9682 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9683 processing the request.
9684
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009685 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9686 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9687 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9688 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9689 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9690 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9691 overflow attack for example).
9692
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009693 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9694 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9695 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9696 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9697 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9698 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9699 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9700 amplify denial of service attacks.
9701
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009702 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9703 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9704 considered to be safe to retry.
9705
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +01009706 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
9707 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
9708 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
9709 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
9710 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009711
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009712 all-retryable-errors
9713 retry request for any error that are considered
9714 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9715 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9716 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9717
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009718 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9719 not cumulative.
9720
9721 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9722 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9723 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9724 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9725
9726 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9727 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9728 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9729 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9730 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9731 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9732 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9733 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9734 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9735 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9736 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9737 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9738
9739 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9740 should not use this directive.
9741
9742 The default is "conn-failure".
9743
9744 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9745
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009746server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009747 Declare a server in a backend
9748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9749 no | no | yes | yes
9750 Arguments :
9751 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009752 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009753 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009754
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009755 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9756 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9757 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9758 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009759 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9760 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9761 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9762 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9763 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009764 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9765 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9766 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9767 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9768 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9769 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9770 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009771 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009772 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9773 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9774 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9775 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9776 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9777 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009778 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9779 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009780 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9781 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009782
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009783 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009784 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9785 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9786 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9787 adding this value to the client's port.
9788
9789 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9790 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009791 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009792
9793 Examples :
9794 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9795 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009796 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009797 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9798 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9799 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009800
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009801 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9802 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9803 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9804 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9805 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9806
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009807 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9808 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009809
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009810server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009811 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009812 this backend.
9813 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9814 no | no | yes | yes
9815
9816 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
9817 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
9818 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
9819 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
9820 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009821
9822 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9823 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9824
9825 global
9826 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9827
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009828 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009829 load-server-state-from-file
9830
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009831 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009832 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009833
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009834server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9835 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9836 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9838 no | no | yes | yes
9839
9840 Arguments:
9841 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9842
9843 <num | range>
9844 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9845 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9846 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9847 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9848
9849 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9850
9851 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9852
9853 <params*>
9854 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9855 keyword.
9856
9857 Examples:
9858 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9859 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9860 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9861
9862 # or
9863 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9864
9865 # would be equivalent to:
9866 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9867 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9868 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9869
9870
9871
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009872source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009873source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009874source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009875 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9877 yes | no | yes | yes
9878 Arguments :
9879 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9880 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009881
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009882 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009883 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9884 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9885 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9886 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9887 supported prefixes are :
9888 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9889 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9890 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009891 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009892 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9893 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009894
9895 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9896 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009897 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9898 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9899 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009900
9901 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9902 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9903 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9904 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9905 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9906 <addr>.
9907
9908 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9909 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9910 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9911 port.
9912
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009913 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9914 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9915 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9916 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009917 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009918 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9919 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9920 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9921 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9922 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9923 HTTP header.
9924
9925 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9926 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009927 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009928 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9929 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9930 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9931 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9932 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9933 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9934 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9935
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009936 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9937 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9938 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9939 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9940 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9941 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9942
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009943 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9944 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9945 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9946 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9947
9948 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9949 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9950 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9951 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9952 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9953 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9954
9955 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9956 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9957 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9958 there are two methods :
9959
9960 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9961 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9962 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9963 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9964 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9965 of the client ranges may be used.
9966
9967 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9968 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9969 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9970 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9971 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9972 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9973 same session.
9974
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009975 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9976 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9977 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009978 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009979
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009980 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9981
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009982 Examples :
9983 backend private
9984 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9985 source 192.168.1.200
9986
9987 backend transparent_ssl1
9988 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9989 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9990
9991 backend transparent_ssl2
9992 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9993 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9994 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9995
9996 backend transparent_ssl3
9997 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9998 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9999 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10000
10001 backend transparent_smtp
10002 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10003 # with Tproxy version 4.
10004 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10005
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010006 backend transparent_http
10007 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10008 # proxy.
10009 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10010
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010011 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010012 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10013
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010014
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010015srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10016 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10017 the connection on the server side.
10018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10019 yes | no | yes | yes
10020 Arguments :
10021 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10022
10023 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10024 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010025 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10026 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010027
10028 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10029
10030
10031srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10032 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10033 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10034 server side.
10035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10036 yes | no | yes | yes
10037 Arguments :
10038 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10039 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10040 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10041 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10042
10043 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10044 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010045 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10046 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010047
10048 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10049
10050
10051srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10052 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10054 yes | no | yes | yes
10055 Arguments :
10056 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10057 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10058 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10059 document.
10060
10061 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10062 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010063 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10064 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010065
10066 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10067
10068
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010069stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10070 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010072 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010073
10074 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10075 matched.
10076
10077 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10078 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10079
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010080 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10081 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010082 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010083
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010084 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10085 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10086 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10087 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010088
10089 Example :
10090 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10091 backend stats_localhost
10092 stats enable
10093 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10094
10095 Example :
10096 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10097 backend stats_auth
10098 stats enable
10099 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10100 stats admin if TRUE
10101
10102 Example :
10103 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10104 userlist stats-auth
10105 group admin users admin
10106 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10107 group readonly users haproxy
10108 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10109
10110 backend stats_auth
10111 stats enable
10112 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10113 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10114 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10115 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10116
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010117 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10118 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10119 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010120
10121
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010122stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10123 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010125 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010126 Arguments :
10127 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10128
10129 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10130
10131 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10132 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10133 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10134 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10135 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10136 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10137
10138 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10139 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10140 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010141 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010142
10143 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10144 report using "stats scope".
10145
10146 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10147 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10148 unobvious parameters.
10149
10150 Example :
10151 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10152 backend public_www
10153 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10154 stats enable
10155 stats hide-version
10156 stats scope .
10157 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010158 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010159 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10160 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10161
10162 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10163 backend private_monitoring
10164 stats enable
10165 stats uri /admin?stats
10166 stats refresh 5s
10167
10168 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10169
10170
10171stats enable
10172 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010174 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010175 Arguments : none
10176
10177 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10178 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10179 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10180 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10181 - stats auth : no authentication
10182 - stats scope : no restriction
10183
10184 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10185 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10186 unobvious parameters.
10187
10188 Example :
10189 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10190 backend public_www
10191 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10192 stats enable
10193 stats hide-version
10194 stats scope .
10195 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010196 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010197 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10198 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10199
10200 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10201 backend private_monitoring
10202 stats enable
10203 stats uri /admin?stats
10204 stats refresh 5s
10205
10206 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10207
10208
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010209stats hide-version
10210 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010212 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010213 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010214
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010215 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10216 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10217 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10218 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10219 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10220 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010221
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010222 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10223 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10224 unobvious parameters.
10225
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010226 Example :
10227 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10228 backend public_www
10229 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010230 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010231 stats hide-version
10232 stats scope .
10233 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010234 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010235 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10236 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010237
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010238 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10239 backend private_monitoring
10240 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010241 stats uri /admin?stats
10242 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010243
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010244 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010245
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010246
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010247stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10248 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10249 Access control for statistics
10250
10251 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10252 no | no | yes | yes
10253
10254 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10255 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10256 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10257 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10258 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10259 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10260
10261 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10262 instance.
10263
10264 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10265 about ACL usage.
10266
10267
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010268stats realm <realm>
10269 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010271 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010272 Arguments :
10273 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10274 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10275 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10276
10277 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10278 using a backslash ('\').
10279
10280 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10281 only related to authentication.
10282
10283 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10284 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10285 unobvious parameters.
10286
10287 Example :
10288 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10289 backend public_www
10290 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10291 stats enable
10292 stats hide-version
10293 stats scope .
10294 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010295 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010296 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10297 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10298
10299 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10300 backend private_monitoring
10301 stats enable
10302 stats uri /admin?stats
10303 stats refresh 5s
10304
10305 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10306
10307
10308stats refresh <delay>
10309 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010311 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010312 Arguments :
10313 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10314 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10315 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10316 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10317 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10318 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10319
10320 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10321 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10322 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010323 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010324
10325 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10326 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10327 unobvious parameters.
10328
10329 Example :
10330 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10331 backend public_www
10332 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10333 stats enable
10334 stats hide-version
10335 stats scope .
10336 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010337 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010338 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10339 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10340
10341 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10342 backend private_monitoring
10343 stats enable
10344 stats uri /admin?stats
10345 stats refresh 5s
10346
10347 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10348
10349
10350stats scope { <name> | "." }
10351 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010353 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010354 Arguments :
10355 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10356 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10357 section in which the statement appears.
10358
10359 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10360 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10361 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10362 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10363 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10364 exists.
10365
10366 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10367 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10368 unobvious parameters.
10369
10370 Example :
10371 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10372 backend public_www
10373 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10374 stats enable
10375 stats hide-version
10376 stats scope .
10377 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010378 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010379 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10380 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10381
10382 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10383 backend private_monitoring
10384 stats enable
10385 stats uri /admin?stats
10386 stats refresh 5s
10387
10388 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10389
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010390
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010391stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010392 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010394 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010395
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010396 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010397 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10398
10399 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10400 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10401
10402 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10403 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010404 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010405
10406 Example :
10407 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10408 backend private_monitoring
10409 stats enable
10410 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10411 stats uri /admin?stats
10412 stats refresh 5s
10413
10414 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10415 global section.
10416
10417
10418stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010419 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10421 yes | yes | yes | yes
10422 Arguments : none
10423
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010424 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010425 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10426 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10427 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10428 - IP (socket, server)
10429 - cookie (backend, server)
10430
10431 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10432 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010433 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010434
10435 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10436
10437
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010438stats show-modules
10439 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10441 yes | yes | yes | yes
10442 Arguments : none
10443
10444 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10445 values as a tooltip.
10446
10447 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10448 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10449 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10450
10451 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10452
10453
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010454stats show-node [ <name> ]
10455 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010457 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010458 Arguments:
10459 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10460 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10461
10462 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10463 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010464 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010465
10466 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10467 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10468 unobvious parameters.
10469
10470 Example:
10471 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10472 backend private_monitoring
10473 stats enable
10474 stats show-node Europe-1
10475 stats uri /admin?stats
10476 stats refresh 5s
10477
10478 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10479 section.
10480
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010481
10482stats uri <prefix>
10483 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010485 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010486 Arguments :
10487 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10488 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10489 query string.
10490
10491 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10492 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10493 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10494 possible to reach it in the application.
10495
10496 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010497 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010498 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10499 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10500 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10501 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10502
10503 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10504 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10505 an address or a port to statistics only.
10506
10507 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10508 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10509 unobvious parameters.
10510
10511 Example :
10512 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10513 backend public_www
10514 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10515 stats enable
10516 stats hide-version
10517 stats scope .
10518 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010519 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010520 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10521 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10522
10523 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10524 backend private_monitoring
10525 stats enable
10526 stats uri /admin?stats
10527 stats refresh 5s
10528
10529 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10530
10531
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010532stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10533 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010535 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010536
10537 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010538 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010539 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010540 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010541 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10542
10543 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10544 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10545 the "stick-table" statement.
10546
10547 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10548 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10549 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10550 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10551 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10552
10553 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10554 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10555 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10556 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10557 transformation rules.
10558
10559 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10560 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10561 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10562 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10563 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10564 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10565 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10566
10567 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10568 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10569 ACL based conditions.
10570
10571 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10572 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10573 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10574 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10575
10576 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10577 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10578 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10579 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10580
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010581 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10582 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010583 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010584
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010585 Example :
10586 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10587 # last 30 minutes
10588 backend pop
10589 mode tcp
10590 balance roundrobin
10591 stick store-request src
10592 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10593 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10594 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10595
10596 backend smtp
10597 mode tcp
10598 balance roundrobin
10599 stick match src table pop
10600 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10601 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10602
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010603 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010604 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010605
10606
10607stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10608 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10610 no | no | yes | yes
10611
10612 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10613 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10614 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10615 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10616
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010617 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10618 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010619 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010620
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010621 Examples :
10622 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010623 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010624
10625 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10626 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10627 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10628
10629
10630 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10631 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10632 backend http
10633 mode http
10634 balance roundrobin
10635 stick on src table https
10636 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10637 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10638 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10639
10640 backend https
10641 mode tcp
10642 balance roundrobin
10643 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10644 stick on src
10645 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10646 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10647
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010648 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010649
10650
10651stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10652 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10654 no | no | yes | yes
10655
10656 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010657 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010658 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010659 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010660 server is selected.
10661
10662 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10663 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10664 the "stick-table" statement.
10665
10666 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10667 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10668 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10669 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10670 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10671 address.
10672
10673 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10674 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10675 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10676 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10677 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10678 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10679 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10680 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10681 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10682 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10683
10684 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10685 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10686 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10687 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10688 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10689 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10690 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10691
10692 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10693 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10694 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10695 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10696
10697 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10698 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10699 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10700 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10701 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10702 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010703 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10704 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10705 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10706 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10707 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10708 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010709
10710 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10711 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10712 the request.
10713
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010714 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10715 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010716 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010717
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010718 Example :
10719 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10720 # last 30 minutes
10721 backend pop
10722 mode tcp
10723 balance roundrobin
10724 stick store-request src
10725 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10726 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10727 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10728
10729 backend smtp
10730 mode tcp
10731 balance roundrobin
10732 stick match src table pop
10733 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10734 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10735
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010736 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010737 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010738
10739
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010740stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070010741 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010742 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010743 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010745 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010746
10747 Arguments :
10748 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10749 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10750 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10751 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10752
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010753 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10754 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10755 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10756 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10757
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010758 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10759 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10760 instance.
10761
10762 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10763 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10764 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10765 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10766 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10767 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010768 to 32 characters.
10769
10770 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10771 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10772 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010773 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010774 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10775 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010776
10777 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010778 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10779 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010780 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10781 increase.
10782
10783 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010784 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10785 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10786 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010787
10788 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10789 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10790 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10791 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010792 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010793 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10794 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10795 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10796 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10797 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10798 parameter (see below).
10799
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010800 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10801 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10802 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10803 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10804 soft restart.
10805
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010806 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10807 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010808
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010809 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10810 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10811 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10812 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010010813 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010814 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010815 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10816 if not expiration delay is specified.
10817
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070010818 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
10819 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
10820 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
10821 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
10822 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
10823 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
10824 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
10825 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
10826 token.
10827
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010828 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10829 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10830 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10831 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010832 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10833 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10834 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10835 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10836 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10837 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10838 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10839 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10840 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10841 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10842 types and their arguments.
10843
10844 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10845 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10846 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10847 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10848
10849 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10850 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10851 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010852 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010853
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010854 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10855 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10856 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010857 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010858 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010859 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010860
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010861 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10862 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10863 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10864 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10865
10866 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10867 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10868 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10869 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10870 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10871 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10872
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010873 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10874 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10875 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10876 they were received.
10877
10878 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10879 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10880 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10881 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10882 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10883
10884 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10885 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10886 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10887 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10888 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10889
10890 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10891 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10892 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10893
10894 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10895 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10896 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10897 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10898 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10899
10900 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10901 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10902 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10903 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10904 the client side.
10905
10906 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10907 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10908 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10909 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10910 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10911 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10912 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10913
10914 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10915 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10916 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10917 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10918 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10919 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010920 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010921
10922 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10923 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10924 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10925 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10926 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10927 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10928
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010010929 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10930 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
10931 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10932 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
10933 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
10934
10935 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10936 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10937 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10938 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10939 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
10940 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10941
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010942 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010943 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010944 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10945 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10946
10947 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10948 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10949 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10950 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10951 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10952 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10953 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10954 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10955 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10956 recommended for better fairness.
10957
10958 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010959 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010960 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10961 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10962
10963 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10964 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10965 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10966 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10967 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10968 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10969 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10970 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10971 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10972 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010973
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010974 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10975 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010976 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10977 reference it.
10978
10979 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10980 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010981 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10982 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10983 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010984
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010985 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10986 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10987 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10988 something that can be ignored.
10989
10990 Example:
10991 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10992 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10993 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10994 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10995
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010010996 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010997 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010998
10999
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011000stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011001 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11003 no | no | yes | yes
11004
11005 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011006 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011007 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011008 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011009 server is selected.
11010
11011 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11012 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11013 the "stick-table" statement.
11014
11015 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11016 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11017 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11018 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11019
11020 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11021 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11022 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11023 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11024 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11025 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011026 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011027 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11028 rules.
11029
11030 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11031 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11032 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11033 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11034 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11035 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11036 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11037
11038 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11039 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11040 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11041 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11042
11043 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11044 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11045 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11046 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11047 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11048 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011049 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11050 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11051 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11052 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11053 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11054 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11055 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11056 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11057 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011058
11059 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11060
11061 Example :
11062 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11063 backend https
11064 mode tcp
11065 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011066 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011067 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011068
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011069 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11070 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11071
11072 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11073 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11074 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11075
11076 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11077 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011078
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011079 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11080 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11081 # at offset 44.
11082
11083 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11084 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11085
11086 # Learn on response if server hello.
11087 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011088
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011089 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11090 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11091
11092 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11093 extraction.
11094
11095
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011096tcp-check comment <string>
11097 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11098 it fails.
11099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11100 yes | no | yes | yes
11101
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011102 Arguments :
11103 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11104 rule fails.
11105
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011106 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11107 user-friendly error reporting.
11108
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011109 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11110 "tcp-check expect".
11111
11112
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011113tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11114 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011115 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011116 Opens a new connection
11117 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011118 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011119
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011120 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011121 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11122
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011123 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011124 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011125
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011126 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011127 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11128 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011129 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011130
11131 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011132
11133 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11134
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011135 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11136
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011137 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11138
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011139 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11140
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011141 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11142 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11143 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11144 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11145
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011146 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11147 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11148 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11149 haproxy -vv.
11150
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011151 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011152
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011153 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11154 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11155 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11156
11157 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11158 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11159 of the sequence.
11160
11161 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11162 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11163 do.
11164
11165 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11166 unset-var or comment rules.
11167
11168 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011169 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11170 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11171 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11172 option tcp-check
11173 tcp-check connect
11174 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11175 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11176 tcp-check send \r\n
11177 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11178 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11179 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11180 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11181 tcp-check send \r\n
11182 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11183 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11184
11185 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11186 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011187 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011188 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11189 tcp-check connect port 143
11190 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11191 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11192
11193 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11194
11195
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011196tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011197 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011198 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011199 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011200 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011201 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011202 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011203
11204 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011205 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11206
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011207 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11208 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11209 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11210 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11211 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11212 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11213 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11214 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11215 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11216 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11217
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011218 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011219 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11220 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011221 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11222 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11223 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11224
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011225 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11226 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11227 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011228 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11229 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011230 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11231 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011232 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11233 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011234 By default "L7OK" is used.
11235
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011236 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11237 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011238 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11239 supported :
11240 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11241 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011242 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11243 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11244 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11245 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11246 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011247
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011248 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011249 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011250 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11251 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11252 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11253 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011254 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11255
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011256 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11257 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11258 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11259 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11260
11261 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11262 informational message reported in logs if an error
11263 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11264 log-format string.
11265
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011266 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11267 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11268 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11269 followed by some converters.
11270
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011271 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11272 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11273 with the usual backslash ('\').
11274 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011275 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011276 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11277 used upper or lower case.
11278
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011279 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11280
11281 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11282 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11283 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11284 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11285 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11286 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11287 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11288 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11289
11290 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11291 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11292 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11293 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11294 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11295 expression.
11296
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011297 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11298 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11299 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11300 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11301 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11302 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11303
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011304 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11305 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11306 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11307 this exact hexadecimal string.
11308 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11309
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011310 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11311 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11312 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11313 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11314 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11315 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11316 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11317 size.
11318
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011319 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11320 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11321 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11322 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11323 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11324 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11325 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11326 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11327 in a binary string before matching the response's
11328 buffer.
11329
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011330 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011331 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011332 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11333 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11334 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11335 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11336 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11337 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11338 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11339 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11340 the null character.
11341
11342 Examples :
11343 # perform a POP check
11344 option tcp-check
11345 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11346
11347 # perform an IMAP check
11348 option tcp-check
11349 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11350
11351 # look for the redis master server
11352 option tcp-check
11353 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011354 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011355 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11356 tcp-check expect string role:master
11357 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11358 tcp-check expect string +OK
11359
11360
11361 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011362 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011363
11364
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011365tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11366tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11367 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11368 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011369 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011370 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011371
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011372 Arguments :
11373 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11374
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011375 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11376 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011377
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011378 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11379 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011380
11381 Examples :
11382 # look for the redis master server
11383 option tcp-check
11384 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11385 tcp-check expect string role:master
11386
11387 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011388 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011389
11390
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011391tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11392tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11393 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11394 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011395 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011396 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011397
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011398 Arguments :
11399 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011400
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011401 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11402 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011403
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011404 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11405 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11406 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011407
11408 Examples :
11409 # redis check in binary
11410 option tcp-check
11411 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11412 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11413
11414
11415 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011416 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011417
11418
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011419tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011420 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011421 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011422 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011423
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011424 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011425 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11426 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11427 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11428 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11429 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11430 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11431 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11432 and '-'.
11433
11434 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11435
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011436 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011437 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11438
11439
11440tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011441 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011442 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011443 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011444
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011445 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011446 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11447 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11448 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11449 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11450 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11451 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11452 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11453 and '-'.
11454
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011455 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011456 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11457
11458
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011459tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11460 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11462 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011463 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011464 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11465 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011466
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011467 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011468
11469 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11470 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011471 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11472 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11473 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11474 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11475 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11476 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011477
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011478 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11479 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11480 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11481 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011482
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011483 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011484 - accept :
11485 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11486 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11487 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011488
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011489 - reject :
11490 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11491 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11492 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11493 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11494 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11495 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11496 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11497 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11498 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11499 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11500 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011501 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011502
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011503 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11504 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11505 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11506 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11507 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11508 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11509 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11510 hosts.
11511
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011512 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11513 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11514 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11515 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11516 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11517 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11518 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11519 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11520
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011521 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11522 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11523 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11524 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11525 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11526 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11527 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11528 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11529 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011530 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11531 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011532
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011533 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011534 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011535 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11536 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11537 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011538 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011539 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011540 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11541 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11542 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11543 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11544 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11545 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11546 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011547
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011548 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011549 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011550 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011551 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011552 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11553 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11554 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011555
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011556 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11557 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11558 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11559 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011560
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011561 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11562 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11563 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11564 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11565 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011566 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11567 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11568 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11569 layer7 information is extracted.
11570
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011571 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11572 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11573 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11574 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11575 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011576
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011577 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11578 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11579 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11580 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11581
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011582 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11583 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11584 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11585 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11586
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011587 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11588 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11589 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11590 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11591 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011592
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011593 - set-src <expr> :
11594 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11595 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11596 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011597 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011598
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011599 Arguments:
11600 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11601 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011602
11603 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011604 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11605
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011606 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11607 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011608
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011609 - set-src-port <expr> :
11610 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11611 expression.
11612
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011613 Arguments:
11614 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11615 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011616
11617 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011618 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11619
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011620 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11621 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11622 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011623
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011624 - set-dst <expr> :
11625 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11626 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11627 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11628 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11629 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11630
11631 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11632 followed by some converters.
11633
11634 Example:
11635
11636 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11637 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11638
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011639 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11640 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11641
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011642 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11643 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11644 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11645 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11646
11647
11648 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11649 followed by some converters.
11650
11651 Example:
11652
11653 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11654
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011655 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11656 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11657 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11658
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011659 - "silent-drop" :
11660 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011661 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011662 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11663 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11664 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11665 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11666 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011667 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11668 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011669 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11670 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011671 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011672 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11673 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11674 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11675 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11676
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011677 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11678 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11679 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011680
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011681 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11682 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11683 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011684
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011685 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011686 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011687 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011688
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011689 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11690 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11691 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011692
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011693 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011694 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11695 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011696
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011697 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11698
11699 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11700
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011701 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11702
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011703 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011704
11705
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011706tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11707 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011709 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011710 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011711 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11712 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011713
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011714 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011715
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011716 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011717 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11718 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11719 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11720 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011721
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011722 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11723 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11724 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11725 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011726 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11727 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11728 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11729 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11730 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11731 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011732 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011733 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011734
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011735 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11736 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11737 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11738 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011739
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011740 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011741 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011742 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011743 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11744 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011745 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011746 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011747 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011748 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011749 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011750 - set-dst <expr>
11751 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011752 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011753 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011754 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011755 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011756 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011757
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011758 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11759 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011760 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11761 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011762
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011763 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11764 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11765 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11766 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11767 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11768 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011769
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011770 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011771 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11772 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011773
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011774 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11775 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11776 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11777 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11778 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11779 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11780
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011781 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011782 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11783 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11784 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11785 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11786 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11787 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11788 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11789 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11790 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11791 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011792
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011793 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011794 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11795 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11796 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011797
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011798 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11799 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11800
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011801 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011802 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11803 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011804
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011805 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11806 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011807 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011808 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11809 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011810 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011811 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011812 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011813 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11814 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011815 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011816 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11817 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011818
11819 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11820 followed by some converters.
11821
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011822 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11823 <var-name>.
11824
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011825 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11826 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11827 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11828 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11829 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11830
11831 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11832 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11833 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11834 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11835 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11836 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11837 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11838 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11839 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11840 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11841 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11842
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011843 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11844 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11845 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11846 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11847 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11848
11849 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11850
11851 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11852
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011853 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11854 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11855 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11856 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11857 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11858 evaluated.
11859
11860 Example:
11861 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11862
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011863 Example:
11864
11865 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011866 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011867
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011868 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011869 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11870 # and reject everything else.
11871 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11872 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011873 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011874 tcp-request content reject
11875
11876 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011877 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11878 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11879 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011880 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011881
11882 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11883 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11884 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011885 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011886 tcp-request content reject
11887
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011888 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011889 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011890 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011891 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011892 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11893 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011894
11895 Example:
11896 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11897 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011898 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011899
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011900 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011901 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011902
11903 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011904 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011905 # protecting all our sites
11906 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011907 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11908 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011909 ...
11910 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11911
11912 backend http_dynamic
11913 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011914 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011915 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011916 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011917 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011918 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011919 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011920
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011921 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011922
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011923 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11924 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011925
11926
11927tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11928 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011930 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011931 Arguments :
11932 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11933 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11934 as explained at the top of this document.
11935
11936 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11937 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11938 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11939 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11940 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11941
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011942 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11943 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11944 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11945 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11946
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011947 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11948 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011949 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011950 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011951 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11952 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11953 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11954 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011955
11956 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11957 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11958 it pass through unaffected.
11959
11960 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11961 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11962 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011963 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011964 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11965 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011966 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11967 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11968 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011969
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011970 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011971 "timeout client".
11972
11973
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011974tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11975 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11977 no | no | yes | yes
11978 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011979 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11980 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011981
11982 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11983
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011984 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011985 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11986 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011987 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11988 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011989
11990 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11991
11992 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11993 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11994 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11995 inserted.
11996
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011997 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011998 - accept :
11999 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12000 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12001 the rules evaluation.
12002
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012003 - close :
12004 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12005 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12006 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12007 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12008 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12009 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012010 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012011 protocols.
12012
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012013 - reject :
12014 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12015 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012016 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012017
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012018 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12019 Sets a variable.
12020
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012021 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12022 Unsets a variable.
12023
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012024 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12025 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12026 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12027 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12028
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012029 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12030 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12031 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12032 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12033
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012034 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12035 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12036 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12037 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12038 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012039
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012040 - "silent-drop" :
12041 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012042 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012043 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12044 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12045 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12046 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12047 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012048 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12049 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012050 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12051 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012052 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012053 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12054 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12055 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12056 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12057
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012058 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12059 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12060
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012061 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12062 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12063 for changing the default action to a reject.
12064
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012065 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12066 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12067 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12068 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012069 period.
12070
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012071 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12072 declared inline.
12073
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012074 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12075 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012076 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012077 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12078 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012079 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012080 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012081 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012082 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12083 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012084 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012085 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12086 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012087
12088 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12089 followed by some converters.
12090
12091 Example:
12092
12093 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12094
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012095 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12096 <var-name>.
12097
12098 Example:
12099
12100 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12101
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012102 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12103 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12104 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12105 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12106 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12107
12108 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12109
12110 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12111
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012112 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12113
12114 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12115
12116
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012117tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12118 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12120 no | yes | yes | no
12121 Arguments :
12122 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12123 below.
12124
12125 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12126
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012127 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012128 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12129 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12130 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12131 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12132 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12133 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12134 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012135 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012136 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12137 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12138 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12139 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12140 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12141 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12142 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12143 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12144 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12145 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12146 instead.
12147
12148 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12149 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12150 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12151 rules which may be inserted.
12152
12153 Several types of actions are supported :
12154 - accept : the request is accepted
12155 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12156 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12157 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012158 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012159 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012160 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012161 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012162 - silent-drop
12163
12164 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12165 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12166 sections for a complete description.
12167
12168 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12169 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12170 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12171
12172 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12173 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12174 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12175 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12176 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12177
12178 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12179 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12180
12181 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12182 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12183 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12184
12185 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12186 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12187 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12188
12189 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12190 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12191 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12192
12193 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12194 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12195 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12196
12197 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12198
12199 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12200
12201
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012202tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12203 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12205 no | no | yes | yes
12206 Arguments :
12207 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12208 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12209 as explained at the top of this document.
12210
12211 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12212
12213
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012214timeout check <timeout>
12215 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12216 established.
12217
12218 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12219 yes | no | yes | yes
12220 Arguments:
12221 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12222 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12223 as explained at the top of this document.
12224
12225 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12226 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012227 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012228 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012229 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12230 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12231 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012232
12233 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12234 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12235
12236 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12237 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012238 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012239
12240 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12241 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12242 forget about it.
12243
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012244 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12245 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012246
12247
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012248timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012249 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12251 yes | yes | yes | no
12252 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012253 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012254 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12255 as explained at the top of this document.
12256
12257 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12258 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12259 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012260 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12261 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12262 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12263 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012264 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12265 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12266 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012267 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012268 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012269 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12270 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012271 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12272 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012273
12274 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12275 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12276 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12277 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012278 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012279 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12280
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012281 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012282
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012283 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012284
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012285
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012286timeout client-fin <timeout>
12287 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12289 yes | yes | yes | no
12290 Arguments :
12291 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12292 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12293 as explained at the top of this document.
12294
12295 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12296 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12297 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12298 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12299 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12300 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12301 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012302 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12303 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12304 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012305
12306 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12307 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12308 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12309
12310 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12311
12312
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012313timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012314 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12316 yes | no | yes | yes
12317 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012318 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012319 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12320 as explained at the top of this document.
12321
12322 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012323 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012324 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012325 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012326 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12327 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012328
12329 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12330 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12331 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12332 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012333 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012334 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12335
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012336 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012337
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012338
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012339timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12340 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12342 yes | yes | yes | yes
12343 Arguments :
12344 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12345 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12346 as explained at the top of this document.
12347
12348 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12349 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12350 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12351 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12352 once the request has started to present itself.
12353
12354 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12355 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12356 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12357 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12358 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12359
12360 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12361 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12362 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12363 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12364
12365 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12366 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012367 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012368 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12369 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012370 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012371
12372 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12373 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12374 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12375 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12376
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012377 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12378 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012379 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12380
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012381 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12382
12383
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012384timeout http-request <timeout>
12385 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012387 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012388 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012389 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012390 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12391 as explained at the top of this document.
12392
12393 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12394 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12395 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12396 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12397 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12398 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12399 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012400 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12401 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12402 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12403 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012404 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012405 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12406 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012407
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012408 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12409 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12410 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12411 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12412 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012413 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012414
12415 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12416 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012417 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012418 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12419 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12420
12421 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012422 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12423 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12424 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012425
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012426 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012427 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012428
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012429
12430timeout queue <timeout>
12431 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12433 yes | no | yes | yes
12434 Arguments :
12435 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12436 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12437 as explained at the top of this document.
12438
12439 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12440 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12441 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12442 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12443 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12444
12445 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12446 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12447 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12448 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12449
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012450 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012451
12452
12453timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012454 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12456 yes | no | yes | yes
12457 Arguments :
12458 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12459 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12460 as explained at the top of this document.
12461
12462 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12463 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12464 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12465 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12466 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12467 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12468 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12469
12470 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12471 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12472 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12473 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12474 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012475 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012476 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012477 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12478 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012479 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12480 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012481
12482 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12483 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12484 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12485 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012486 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012487 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12488
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012489 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012490
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012491
12492timeout server-fin <timeout>
12493 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12495 yes | no | yes | yes
12496 Arguments :
12497 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12498 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12499 as explained at the top of this document.
12500
12501 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12502 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12503 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12504 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12505 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12506 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12507 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12508 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12509 situations, it should not be needed.
12510
12511 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12512 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12513 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12514
12515 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12516
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012517
12518timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012519 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12521 yes | yes | yes | yes
12522 Arguments :
12523 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12524 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12525 as explained at the top of this document.
12526
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012527 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12528 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12529 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012530
12531 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12532 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12533 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12534 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012535 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012536
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012537 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012538
12539
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012540timeout tunnel <timeout>
12541 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12543 yes | no | yes | yes
12544 Arguments :
12545 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12546 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12547 as explained at the top of this document.
12548
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012549 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012550 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12551 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12552 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012553 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12554 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012555 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12556 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12557 specified.
12558
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012559 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12560 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12561 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12562 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12563 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12564 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12565 state.
12566
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012567 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12568 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12569 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12570 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012571 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012572
12573 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12574 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12575 forget about it.
12576
12577 Example :
12578 defaults http
12579 option http-server-close
12580 timeout connect 5s
12581 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012582 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012583 timeout server 30s
12584 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12585
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012586 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012587
12588
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012589transparent (deprecated)
12590 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012592 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012593 Arguments : none
12594
12595 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12596 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12597 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12598 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12599 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12600 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12601 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12602 appropriate server.
12603
12604 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12605
12606 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12607 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12608
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012609 See also: "option transparent"
12610
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012611unique-id-format <string>
12612 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12614 yes | yes | yes | no
12615 Arguments :
12616 <string> is a log-format string.
12617
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012618 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12619 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12620 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12621 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012622
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012623 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12624 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12625 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12626 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12627 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12628 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12629 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12630 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012631
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012632 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12633 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012634
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012635 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012636
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012637 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012638
12639 will generate:
12640
12641 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12642
12643 See also: "unique-id-header"
12644
12645unique-id-header <name>
12646 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12648 yes | yes | yes | no
12649 Arguments :
12650 <name> is the name of the header.
12651
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012652 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12653 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012654
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012655 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012656
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012657 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012658 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12659
12660 will generate:
12661
12662 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12663
12664 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012665
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012666use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012667 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12669 no | yes | yes | no
12670 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012671 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12672 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012673
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012674 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12675 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012676
12677 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12678 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12679 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012680 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012681 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012682 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12683 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012684
12685 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12686 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12687 assign the backend.
12688
12689 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12690 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12691 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12692 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12693 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12694 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12695
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012696 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012697 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012698 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12699 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12700 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12701
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012702 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12703 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12704 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12705 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12706 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12707 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12708 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12709 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12710 cannot be forced from the request.
12711
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012712 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012713 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12714 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12715
12716 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12717 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012718
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012719use-fcgi-app <name>
12720 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12722 no | no | yes | yes
12723 Arguments :
12724 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12725
12726 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012727
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012728use-server <server> if <condition>
12729use-server <server> unless <condition>
12730 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12732 no | no | yes | yes
12733 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012734 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12735 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012736
12737 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12738
12739 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12740 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12741 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12742
12743 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12744 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12745 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12746 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12747 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12748 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12749 matches will assign the server.
12750
12751 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12752 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12753 with the next rules until one matches.
12754
12755 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12756 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12757 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12758 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12759
12760 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12761 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12762 stripped.
12763
12764 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12765 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012766 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12767 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12768 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012769
12770 Example :
12771 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12772 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12773 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12774 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012775 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012776 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012777 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012778 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12779 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12780
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012781 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12782 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12783 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12784 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012785 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012786 and we fall back to load balancing.
12787
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012788 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012789
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012790
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100127915. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012792--------------------------
12793
12794The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12795depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12796settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12797written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12798described in this section.
12799
12800
128015.1. Bind options
12802-----------------
12803
12804The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12805as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12806no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12807parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12808while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12809provided immediately after the setting name.
12810
12811The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12812
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012813accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12814 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12815 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12816 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12817 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12818 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12819 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12820 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12821 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12822 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012823 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12824 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12825 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012826
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012827accept-proxy
12828 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012829 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12830 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012831 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12832 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12833 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12834 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012835 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012836 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12837 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012838 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12839 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012840
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012841allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012842 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012843 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012844 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012845 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12846 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012847
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012848alpn <protocols>
12849 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12850 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12851 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012852 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012853 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012854 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12855 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12856 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12857 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12858 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12859 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12860 preference, like below :
12861
12862 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012863
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012864backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012865 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012866 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12867
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012868curves <curves>
12869 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12870 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12871 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12872 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12873 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12874 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12875
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012876ecdhe <named curve>
12877 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012878 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12879 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012880
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012881ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012882 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12883 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12884 client's certificate.
12885
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012886ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12887 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12888 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12889 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12890 error is ignored.
12891
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012892ca-sign-file <cafile>
12893 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12894 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12895 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12896 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12897 'generate-certificates' for details.
12898
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012899ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012900 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12901 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12902 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12903 'generate-certificates' for details.
12904
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012905ca-verify-file <cafile>
12906 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12907 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12908 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12909 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12910 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12911
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012912ciphers <ciphers>
12913 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12914 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012915 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012916 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012917 information and recommendations see e.g.
12918 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12919 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12920 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12921
12922ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12923 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12924 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12925 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12926 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012927 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12928 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012929
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012930crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012931 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12932 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12933 to verify client's certificate.
12934
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012935crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012936 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12937 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12938 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12939 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12940 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012941 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12942 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012943
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012944 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12945 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12946
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012947 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12948 are loaded.
12949
12950 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012951 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12952 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12953 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12954 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12955 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12956 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12957 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012958 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012959
12960 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12961 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12962 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12963 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012964 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12965 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012966
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012967 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012968
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012969 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012970 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012971 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12972 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012973 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12974 clients).
12975
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012976 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12977 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12978 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12979 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12980 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12981 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12982 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12983 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12984 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12985 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12986 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12987 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12988 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12989
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012990 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12991 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12992 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12993 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12994 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12995
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012996 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12997 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12998 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12999 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013000
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013001 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13002 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13003 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013004
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013005crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013006 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013007 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013008 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013009 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013010
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013011crt-list <file>
13012 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013013 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13014 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013015
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013016 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13017
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013018 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13019 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13020 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13021 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13022 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013023
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013024 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013025 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13026 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13027 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13028 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13029 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013030 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13031 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13032 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013033
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013034 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13035 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13036 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013037
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013038 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13039
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013040 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
13041 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
13042 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13043 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13044 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13045 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13046 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13047 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013048
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013049 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013050 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013051 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013052 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013053 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013054 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013055
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013056defer-accept
13057 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13058 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13059 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013060 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013061 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13062 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13063 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13064 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13065 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13066 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13067 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13068
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013069expose-fd listeners
13070 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13071 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013072 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13073 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013074 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013075
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013076force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013077 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013078 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013079 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013080 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013081
13082force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013083 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013084 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013085 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013086
13087force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013088 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013089 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013090 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013091
13092force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013093 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013094 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013095 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013096
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013097force-tlsv13
13098 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13099 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013100 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013101
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013102generate-certificates
13103 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13104 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13105 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13106 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13107 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13108 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13109 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13110 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13111 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13112 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13113 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13114
13115 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13116 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013117 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013118 certificate is used many times.
13119
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013120gid <gid>
13121 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13122 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13123 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13124 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13125 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13126
13127group <group>
13128 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13129 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13130 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13131 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13132 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13133
13134id <id>
13135 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13136 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13137 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13138 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13139
13140interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013141 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13142 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13143 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13144 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13145 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13146 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013147 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13148 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13149 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13150 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13151 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13152 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013153
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013154level <level>
13155 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13156 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13157 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013158 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013159 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13160 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13161 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013162 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013163 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013164 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013165 all counters).
13166
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013167severity-output <format>
13168 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13169 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13170 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13171 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13172 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13173 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13174 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13175 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13176 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13177 rfc5424 convention.
13178
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013179maxconn <maxconn>
13180 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13181 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13182 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13183 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13184 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13185 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13186 eat all memory.
13187
13188mode <mode>
13189 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13190 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13191 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13192 UNIX sockets.
13193
13194mss <maxseg>
13195 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13196 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13197 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13198 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13199 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13200 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13201 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13202 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13203 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13204 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13205 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13206
13207name <name>
13208 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13209 page.
13210
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013211namespace <name>
13212 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13213 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13214 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13215 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13216
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013217nice <nice>
13218 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13219 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13220 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13221 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13222 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13223 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13224 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13225 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13226 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13227 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13228 one for an RDP socket.
13229
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013230no-ca-names
13231 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13232 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013233 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013234
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013235no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013236 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013237 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013238 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013239 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013240 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13241 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013242
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013243no-tls-tickets
13244 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13245 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13246 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013247 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13248 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013249 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13250 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13251 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013252
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013253no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013254 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013255 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013256 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013257 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013258 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13259 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013260
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013261no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013262 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013263 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013264 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013265 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013266 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13267 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013268
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013269no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013270 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013271 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013272 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013273 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013274 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13275 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013276
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013277no-tlsv13
13278 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13279 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13280 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13281 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013282 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13283 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013284
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013285npn <protocols>
13286 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13287 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13288 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013289 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013290 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013291 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13292 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13293 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13294 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13295 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013296
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013297prefer-client-ciphers
13298 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13299 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13300 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013301 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13302 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13303 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013304
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013305process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013306 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013307 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013308 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013309 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13310 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13311 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13312 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013313 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013314 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13315 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13316 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13317 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13318 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013319
13320 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13321
13322 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13323 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13324 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13325 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13326 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13327 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13328 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13329 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013330
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013331proto <name>
13332 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13333 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13334 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
13335 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013336 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013337 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013338 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013339 h2" on the bind line.
13340
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013341ssl
13342 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013343 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013344 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13345 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013346 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13347 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013348
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013349ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13350 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013351 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13352 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13353 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013354 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13355
13356ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013357 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13358 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13359 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13360 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013361
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013362strict-sni
13363 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13364 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13365 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13366 See the "crt" option for more information.
13367
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013368tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013369 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013370 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13371 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013372 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013373 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13374 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13375 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13376 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13377 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13378 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13379 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13380
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013381tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013382 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013383 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13384 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13385 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13386 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13387 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13388 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13389 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013390 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13391 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13392 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013393
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013394tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13395 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013396 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13397 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13398 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13399 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13400 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13401 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13402 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13403 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13404 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13405 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013406 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13407 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13408
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013409transparent
13410 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13411 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13412 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13413 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13414 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13415 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13416 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13417 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13418 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13419 so check for support with your vendor.
13420
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013421v4v6
13422 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13423 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13424 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13425 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013426 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013427
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013428v6only
13429 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13430 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13431 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013432 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13433 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013434
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013435uid <uid>
13436 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13437 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13438 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13439 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13440 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13441
13442user <user>
13443 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13444 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13445 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13446 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13447 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13448
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013449verify [none|optional|required]
13450 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13451 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13452 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13453 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13454 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013455 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13456 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13457 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13458 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013459
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200134605.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013461------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013462
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013463The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13464which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13465arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13466settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13467after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13468Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13469address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013470
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013471 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013472 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013473
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013474Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13475keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13476
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013477The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013478
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013479addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013480 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013481 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13482 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13483 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13484 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13485 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013486
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013487agent-check
13488 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013489 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013490 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13491 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13492 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013493
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013494 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013495 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013496 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13497 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13498 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013499
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013500 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13501 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13502 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13503 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13504 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013505
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013506 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013507 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013508
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013509 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13510 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13511 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013512
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013513 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13514 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13515 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013516
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013517 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013518 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13519 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13520 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13521 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013522 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013523 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013524
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013525 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13526 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013527
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013528 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13529 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13530 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13531 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13532 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13533 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13534 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13535 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13536 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013537
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013538 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13539 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013540 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13541 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13542 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013543 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013544
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013545 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013546 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013547
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013548agent-send <string>
13549 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13550 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13551 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13552 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13553 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13554
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013555agent-inter <delay>
13556 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13557 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13558
13559 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13560 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13561 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13562 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13563 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13564 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13565 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13566 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13567 of backends use the same servers.
13568
13569 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13570
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013571agent-addr <addr>
13572 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13573
13574 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13575 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13576 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13577 hostname, it will be resolved.
13578
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013579agent-port <port>
13580 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13581
13582 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13583
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013584allow-0rtt
13585 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013586 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13587 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013588
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013589alpn <protocols>
13590 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13591 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13592 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013593 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013594 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13595 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13596 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13597 now obsolete NPN extension.
13598 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13599 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13600
13601 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13602
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013603backup
13604 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13605 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13606 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13607 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013608 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13609 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013610
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013611ca-file <cafile>
13612 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13613 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13614 server's certificate.
13615
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013616check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013617 This option enables health checks on a server:
13618 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13619 considered available.
13620 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13621 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13622 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13623 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13624 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13625 set.
13626 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13627 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13628 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13629 exchanges succeed.
13630
13631 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13632 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13633 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13634 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13635 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013636 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013637 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13638
13639 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13640 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13641
13642 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13643 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13644
13645 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13646 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13647 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13648 available.
13649
13650 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13651 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13652 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13653
13654 Example:
13655 # simple tcp check
13656 backend foo
13657 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13658 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13659 backend foo
13660 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13661 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13662 backend foo
13663 option tcp-check
13664 tcp-check connect
13665 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013666
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013667check-send-proxy
13668 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13669 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13670 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13671 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13672 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13673 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13674 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13675
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013676check-alpn <protocols>
13677 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13678 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13679 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13680
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013681check-proto <name>
13682 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13683 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13684 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13685 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013686 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013687 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13688 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13689
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013690check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013691 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013692 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13693 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013694
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013695check-ssl
13696 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13697 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13698 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13699 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013700 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013701 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13702 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013703 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013704 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13705 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013706
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013707check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013708 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013709 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13710 for normal traffic.
13711
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013712ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013713 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13714 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13715 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013716 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13717 information and recommendations see e.g.
13718 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13719 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13720 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013721
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013722ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13723 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13724 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13725 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13726 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013727 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13728 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13729 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013730
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013731cookie <value>
13732 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13733 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13734 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13735 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13736 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13737 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13738 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13739
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013740crl-file <crlfile>
13741 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13742 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13743 to verify server's certificate.
13744
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013745crt <cert>
13746 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13747 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13748 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13749 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13750 certificate request.
13751
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013752disabled
13753 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13754 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13755 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13756 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13757 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013758 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013759
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013760enabled
13761 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13762 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13763 default value.
13764 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13765 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013766
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013767error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013768 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13769 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13770 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013771
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013772 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013773
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013774fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013775 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13776 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13777 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13778
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013779force-sslv3
13780 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13781 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013782 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013783 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013784
13785force-tlsv10
13786 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013787 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013788 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013789
13790force-tlsv11
13791 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013792 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013793 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013794
13795force-tlsv12
13796 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013797 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013798 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013799
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013800force-tlsv13
13801 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13802 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013803 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013805id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013806 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13807 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13808 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013809
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013810init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13811 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13812 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013813 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013814 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13815 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13816 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13817 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13818 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13819 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13820 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13821 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13822 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013823 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013824 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13825 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13826 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13827 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13828 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13829 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013830 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013831
13832 Example:
13833 defaults
13834 # never fail on address resolution
13835 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13836
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013837inter <delay>
13838fastinter <delay>
13839downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013840 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13841 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13842 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13843 between checks depending on the server state :
13844
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013845 Server state | Interval used
13846 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13847 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13848 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13849 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13850 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13851 or yet unchecked. |
13852 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13853 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13854 | "inter" otherwise.
13855 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013856
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013857 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13858 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13859 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13860 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013861 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13862 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13863 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13864 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13865 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013866
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013867log-proto <logproto>
13868 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13869 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13870 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13871 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13872
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013873maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013874 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13875 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013876 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13877 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013878 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13879 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13880 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13881 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13882
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013883 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13884 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13885 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13886 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13887 than 50 concurrent requests.
13888
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013889maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013890 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13891 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13892 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13893 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020013894 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
13895 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
13896 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
13897 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
13898 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
13899 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
13900 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013901
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013902max-reuse <count>
13903 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13904 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13905 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13906 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13907 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13908 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13909 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13910 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13911
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013912minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013913 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13914 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13915 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13916 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13917 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13918 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013919 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013920 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013921
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013922namespace <name>
13923 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13924 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13925 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13926 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13927
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013928no-agent-check
13929 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13930 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13931 default value.
13932 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13933 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13934
13935no-backup
13936 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13937 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13938 default value.
13939 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13940 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13941
13942no-check
13943 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13944 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13945 default value.
13946 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13947 "default-server" "check" setting.
13948
13949no-check-ssl
13950 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13951 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13952 default value.
13953 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13954 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13955
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013956no-send-proxy
13957 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13958 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13959 default value.
13960 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13961 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13962
13963no-send-proxy-v2
13964 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13965 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13966 default value.
13967 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13968 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13969
13970no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13971 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13972 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13973 default value.
13974 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13975 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13976
13977no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13978 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13979 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13980 default value.
13981 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13982 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13983
13984no-ssl
13985 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13986 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13987 default value.
13988 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13989 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13990
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010013991 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
13992 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
13993 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
13994
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013995no-ssl-reuse
13996 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13997 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13998 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13999 and for paranoid users.
14000
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014001no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014002 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14003 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014004 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014005
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014006 Supported in default-server: No
14007
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014008no-tls-tickets
14009 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14010 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14011 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014012 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14013 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014014 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14015 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14016 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014017 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014018
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014019no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014020 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014021 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14022 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014023 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14024 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014025 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014026
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014027 Supported in default-server: No
14028
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014029no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014030 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014031 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14032 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014033 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14034 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014035 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014036
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014037 Supported in default-server: No
14038
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014039no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014040 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014041 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14042 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014043 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14044 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014045 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014046
14047 Supported in default-server: No
14048
14049no-tlsv13
14050 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14051 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14052 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14053 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14054 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014055 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014056
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014057 Supported in default-server: No
14058
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014059no-verifyhost
14060 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14061 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14062 default value.
14063 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14064 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014065
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014066no-tfo
14067 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14068 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14069 default value.
14070 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14071 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14072
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014073non-stick
14074 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14075 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14076 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14077
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014078npn <protocols>
14079 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14080 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14081 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014082 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014083 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14084 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14085 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14086
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014087observe <mode>
14088 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14089 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14090 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14091 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14092 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14093 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014094 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014095
14096 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14097
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014098on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014099 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14100 Currently, four modes are available:
14101 - fastinter: force fastinter
14102 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14103 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14104 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14105 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14106
14107 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14108
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014109on-marked-down <action>
14110 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14111 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014112 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14113 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14114 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14115 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14116 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14117 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14118 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14119 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014120
14121 Actions are disabled by default
14122
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014123on-marked-up <action>
14124 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14125 Currently one action is available:
14126 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14127 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14128 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14129 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014130 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14131 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014132 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14133 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14134
14135 Actions are disabled by default
14136
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014137pool-low-conn <max>
14138 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14139 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14140 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14141 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14142 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14143 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14144 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14145 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14146 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14147 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
14148 applying to "http-reuse".
14149
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014150pool-max-conn <max>
14151 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14152 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14153 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14154 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14155 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14156 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14157
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014158pool-purge-delay <delay>
14159 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014160 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014161 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014162
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014163port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014164 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014165 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14166 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14167 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14168 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14169 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014170
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014171proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014172 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14173 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14174 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
14175 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014176 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014177 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014179redir <prefix>
14180 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14181 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14182 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14183 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14184 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14185 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14186 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14187 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014188 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014189 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014190 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14191 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14192 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14193 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14194
14195 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14196
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014197rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014198 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14199 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14200 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14201
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014202resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14203 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14204 server.
14205
14206 Available options:
14207
14208 * allow-dup-ip
14209 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14210 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14211 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14212 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14213 For such case, simply enable this option.
14214 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14215
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014216 * ignore-weight
14217 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14218 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14219 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14220
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014221 * prevent-dup-ip
14222 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14223 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14224 same fqdn.
14225 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14226
14227 Example:
14228 backend b_myapp
14229 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14230 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14231 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14232
14233 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14234 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14235 it
14236 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14237 different address
14238
14239 Default value: not set
14240
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014241resolve-prefer <family>
14242 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14243 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14244 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14245 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14246
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014247 Default value: ipv6
14248
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014249 Example:
14250
14251 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014252
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014253resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014254 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014255 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014256 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014257 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14258 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014259 configured network, another address is selected.
14260
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014261 Example:
14262
14263 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014264
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014265resolvers <id>
14266 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14267 hostname.
14268
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014269 Example:
14270
14271 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014272
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014273 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014274
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014275send-proxy
14276 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14277 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14278 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14279 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014280 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14281 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14282 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14283 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14284 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14285 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14286 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14287 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14288 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14289 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014290 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14291 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014292
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014293send-proxy-v2
14294 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14295 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14296 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14297 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014298 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14299 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14300 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14301 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014302
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014303proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014304 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14305 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14306
14307 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14308 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14309 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14310 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14311 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14312 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14313 connection is supported).
14314 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14315 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14316 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14317 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14318 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14319 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14320 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014321
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014322send-proxy-v2-ssl
14323 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14324 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14325 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14326 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14327 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14328 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14329 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014330 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14331 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014332
14333send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14334 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14335 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14336 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14337 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14338 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14339 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14340 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14341 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014342 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14343 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014344
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014345slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014346 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14347 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14348 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14349 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14350 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14351 parameters :
14352
14353 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14354 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14355
14356 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14357 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14358 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14359 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14360
14361 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14362 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14363 seen as failed.
14364
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014365sni <expression>
14366 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14367 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14368 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14369 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014370 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14371 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014372 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014373 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14374 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014375
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014376source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014377source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014378source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014379 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14380 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14381 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14382 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14383
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014384 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14385 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14386 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14387 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14388 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14389 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14390 server.
14391
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014392 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14393 specifying the source address without port(s).
14394
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014395ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014396 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14397 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14398 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14399 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14400 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14401 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014402 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14403 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014404
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014405ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14406 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14407 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14408 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14409
14410ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14411 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14412 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14413 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14414
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014415ssl-reuse
14416 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14417 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14418 default value.
14419 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14420 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14421
14422stick
14423 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14424 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14425 default value.
14426 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14427 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014428
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014429socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014430 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014431 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14432 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14433
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014434tcp-ut <delay>
14435 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14436 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14437 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014438 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014439 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14440 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14441 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14442 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14443 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14444 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14445 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14446 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14447 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14448
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014449tfo
14450 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14451 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14452 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14453 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14454 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014455 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014456
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014457track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014458 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14459 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14460 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14461 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014462 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14463
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014464tls-tickets
14465 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14466 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14467 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014468 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14469 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14470 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014471 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014472 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014473
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014474verify [none|required]
14475 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014476 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014477 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14478 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014479 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014480 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14481 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14482 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14483 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14484 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14485 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14486 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14487 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014488
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014489verifyhost <hostname>
14490 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014491 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14492 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14493 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14494 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14495 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14496 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14497 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14498 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014499
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014500weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014501 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14502 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14503 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014504 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14505 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14506 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14507 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14508 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14509 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014510
14511
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200145125.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14513-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014514
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014515HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14516using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070014517configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014518This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14519can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14520workload.
14521This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14522resolution at run time.
14523Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14524carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14525
14526
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200145275.3.1. Global overview
14528----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014529
14530As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14531different steps of the process life:
14532
14533 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14534 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14535 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14536
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014537 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14538 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014539
14540A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14541 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14542 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14543 resolution to know this new IP.
14544
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014545When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014546HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014547SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14548from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14549will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14550will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014551
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014552A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014553 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014554 first valid response.
14555
14556 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14557 servers return an error.
14558
14559
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200145605.3.2. The resolvers section
14561----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014562
14563This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014564HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14565contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014566
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014567When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14568uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14569is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14570answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14571
14572When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014573used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014574
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014575 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14576 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14577 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014578
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014579 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14580 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014581
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014582 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14583 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14584 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014585
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014586For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14587following scenarios are possible:
14588
14589 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14590 ignored
14591
14592 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14593 applied
14594
14595 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14596 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14597
14598 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14599 retries the query with a new type
14600
14601 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14602 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014603
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014604As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14605a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014606<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014607
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014608
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014609resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014610 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014611
14612A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14613
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014614accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014615 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014616 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014617 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14618 by RFC 6891)
14619
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014620 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14621
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014622nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14623 DNS server description:
14624 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14625 <ip> : IP address of the server
14626 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14627
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014628parse-resolv-conf
14629 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14630 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14631 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14632
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014633hold <status> <period>
14634 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14635 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014636 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014637 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014638 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14639 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14640 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14641
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014642 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014643
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014644resolve_retries <nb>
14645 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14646 giving up.
14647 Default value: 3
14648
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014649 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14650 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14651 type.
14652
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014653timeout <event> <time>
14654 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14655 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14656 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014657 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14658 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014659 Default value: 1s
14660 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014661 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014662 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014663 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14664 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14665
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014666 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014667
14668 resolvers mydns
14669 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14670 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014671 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014672 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014673 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014674 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014675 hold other 30s
14676 hold refused 30s
14677 hold nx 30s
14678 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014679 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014680 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014681
14682
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200146836. Cache
14684---------
14685
14686HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14687(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14688RAM.
14689
14690The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14691this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14692
14693If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14694independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14695when we try to allocate a new one.
14696
14697The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14698
14699It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14700"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14701for more details.
14702
14703When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14704replaced by "<CACHE>".
14705
14706
147076.1. Limitation
14708----------------
14709
14710The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14711
14712- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010014713- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
14714 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
14715 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014716- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14717- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010014718- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
14719 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
14720 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010014721- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
14722 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010014723- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
14724 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
14725 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014726
14727- If the request is not a GET
14728- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14729- If the request contains an Authorization header
14730
14731
147326.2. Setup
14733-----------
14734
14735To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14736the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14737
14738
147396.2.1. Cache section
14740---------------------
14741
14742cache <name>
14743 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14744 size of cache is mandatory.
14745
14746total-max-size <megabytes>
14747 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14748 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14749
14750max-object-size <bytes>
14751 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14752 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14753 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14754
14755max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010014756 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014757 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14758 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14759 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14760 default.
14761
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010014762process-vary <on/off>
14763 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010014764 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
14765 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
14766 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010014767 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010014768
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010014769max-secondary-entries <number>
14770 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
14771 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
14772 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
14773
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014774
147756.2.2. Proxy section
14776---------------------
14777
14778http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14779 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14780 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14781 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14782 after this one.
14783
14784http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14785 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14786 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14787 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14788 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14789
14790
14791Example:
14792
14793 backend bck1
14794 mode http
14795
14796 http-request cache-use foobar
14797 http-response cache-store foobar
14798 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14799
14800 cache foobar
14801 total-max-size 4
14802 max-age 240
14803
14804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200148057. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14806----------------------------------
14807
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014808HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014809client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14810The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14811these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14812but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14813data called patterns.
14814
14815
148167.1. ACL basics
14817---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014818
14819The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14820content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14821from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14822simple :
14823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014824 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014825 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014826 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14827 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014829The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14830adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014831
14832In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014834 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014835
14836This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14837Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14838and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014839an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14840conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14841as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14842are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014843
14844ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14845'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14846which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14847
14848There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14849performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014851The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14852specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14853this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014854methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14855ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014856
14857Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14858 - boolean
14859 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14860 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14861 - string
14862 - data block
14863
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014864Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14865converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14866would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14867The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14868which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14869
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014870Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14871keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14872fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14873which are summarized in the table below :
14874
14875 +---------------------+-----------------+
14876 | Sample or converter | Default |
14877 | output type | matching method |
14878 +---------------------+-----------------+
14879 | boolean | bool |
14880 +---------------------+-----------------+
14881 | integer | int |
14882 +---------------------+-----------------+
14883 | ip | ip |
14884 +---------------------+-----------------+
14885 | string | str |
14886 +---------------------+-----------------+
14887 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14888 +---------------------+-----------------+
14889
14890Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14891matching method, see below.
14892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014893The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14894 - boolean
14895 - integer or integer range
14896 - IP address / network
14897 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14898 - regular expression
14899 - hex block
14900
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014901The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14902
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014903 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14904 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014905 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014906 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014907 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014908 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014909 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014911The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14912read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14913if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14914lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14915will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14916beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14917a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14918lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14919exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14920
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014921The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14922parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14923ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14924a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14925check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14926
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014927The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14928socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14929file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014931Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14932loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14933
14934 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14935
14936In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14937the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14938case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14939as well.
14940
14941The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14942sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14943do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14944methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14945is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014946obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014947followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14948default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14949that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14950string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14951
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014952The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14953By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14954string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14955resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14956server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014957waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014958flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14959function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014961There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14962sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14963be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014964
14965 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14966 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014967 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14968 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14969 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14970 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014971
14972 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14973 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014974 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014975
14976 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014977 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014978
14979 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014980 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014981
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014982 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014983 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14984
14985 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14986 binary or string samples.
14987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014988 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14989 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014991 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14992 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14993 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014995 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14996 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014998 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14999 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015001 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15002 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015004 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15005 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015006 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015008 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15009 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15010 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015011
15012For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15013request, it is possible to do :
15014
15015 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15016
15017In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15018buffer, one would use the following acl :
15019
15020 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15021
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015022On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15023possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15024
15025 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015027All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15028criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15029method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15030to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15031criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15032the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015034If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015035the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15036For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015038 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15039 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15040 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15041 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015042
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015043
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015044The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15045types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15046combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15047brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15048default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015050 +-------------------------------------------------+
15051 | Input sample type |
15052 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015053 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015054 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15055 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15056 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015057 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015058 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015059 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015060 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015061 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015062 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015063 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015064 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015065 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015066 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015067 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015068 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015069 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015070 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015071 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015072 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015073 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015074 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015075 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015076 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015077 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015078 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15079 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15080 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015081
15082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150837.1.1. Matching booleans
15084------------------------
15085
15086In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15087Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15088When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15089that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15090
15091Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15092return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15093"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15094
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150967.1.2. Matching integers
15097------------------------
15098
15099Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15100enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15101to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15102
15103Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15104matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15105lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015106
15107For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15108unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15109representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15110
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015111As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15112two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15113instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15114ranges and operators.
15115
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015116For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015117operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15118Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15119of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015120
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015121Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015122
15123 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15124 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15125 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15126 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15127 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15128
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015129For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015130
15131 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15132
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015133This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15134
15135 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15136
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200151387.1.3. Matching strings
15139-----------------------
15140
15141String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15142different forms :
15143
15144 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015145 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015146
15147 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015148 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015149
15150 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15151 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15152
15153 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15154 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15155
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015156 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015157 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15158 matches.
15159
15160 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15161 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15162 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015163
15164String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15165exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15166characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15167string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15168to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015169before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015170
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015171Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15172(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15173Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15174
15175Example:
15176 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15177 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15178
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200151807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15181---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015182
15183Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15184they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15185possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15186passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15187the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015188the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15189match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015190
15191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200151927.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15193-------------------------------------
15194
15195It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15196not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15197a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15198to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15199digits may be used upper or lower case.
15200
15201Example :
15202 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15203 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15204
15205
152067.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15207---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015208
15209IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15210netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15211within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015212host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015213difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15214at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15215does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15216parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015217
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015218The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15219abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15220
15221 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15222 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15223 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15224 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15225 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15226 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15227 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15228 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15229
15230Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15231192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15232
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015233IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15234Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15235trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15236IPv6 patterns.
15237
15238HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15239following situations :
15240 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15241 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15242 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15243 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15244 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15245 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15246 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15247 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15248 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15249 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015251
152527.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15253----------------------------------
15254
15255Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15256combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15257
15258 - AND (implicit)
15259 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15260 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015262A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015264 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015266Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15267indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015269For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15270"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15271requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15272is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15273
15274 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015275 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15276 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15277 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015278
15279To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15280and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15281
15282 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15283 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15284 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15285 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15286
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015287 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015288 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15289 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15290 use_backend www if host_www
15291
15292It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15293expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15294be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15295the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15296
15297 The following rule :
15298
15299 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015300 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015301
15302 Can also be written that way :
15303
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015304 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015305
15306It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15307to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15308simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15309sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15310good use is the following :
15311
15312 With named ACLs :
15313
15314 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15315 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15316 monitor fail if site_dead
15317
15318 With anonymous ACLs :
15319
15320 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15321
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015322See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15323keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015324
15325
153267.3. Fetching samples
15327---------------------
15328
15329Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15330against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15331sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15332ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15333of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15334available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15335
15336This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15337Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15338compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15339deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15340
15341The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15342matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15343method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15344indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15345
15346As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15347when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15348mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15349the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15350ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15351
15352Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15353multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15354when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015355incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15356are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015357is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15358all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15359
15360Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15361 - name
15362 - name(arg1)
15363 - name(arg1,arg2)
15364
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015365
153667.3.1. Converters
15367-----------------
15368
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015369Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15370of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15371is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15372was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015373has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015374unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15375
15376These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15377sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15378the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015379support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015380
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015381A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15382support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15383supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15384(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15385bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015387The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015388
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001538951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15390 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15391 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15392 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15393 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15394 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15395
15396 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015397 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15398 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015399 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15400 frontend http-in
15401 bind *:8081
15402 default_backend servers
15403 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15404 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15405
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015406add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015407 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015408 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015409 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15410 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015411 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015412 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15413 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15414 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15415 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015416 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015417 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015418
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015419aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15420 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15421 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15422 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15423 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15424 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15425 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15426
15427 Example:
15428 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15429 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15430
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015431and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015432 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015433 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015434 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15435 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015436 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015437 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15438 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15439 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15440 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015441 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015442 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015443
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015444b64dec
15445 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15446 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
15447
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015448base64
15449 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015450 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015451 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
15452
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015453bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015454 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015455 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015456 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015457 presence of a flag).
15458
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015459bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15460 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15461 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015462 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015463
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015464concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15465 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15466 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15467 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15468 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15469 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15470 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15471 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15472 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15473 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15474 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015475 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015476 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015477 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15478 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015479
15480 Example:
15481 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15482 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15483 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015484 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015485 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15486
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015487cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015488 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15489 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015490
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015491crc32([<avalanche>])
15492 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15493 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15494 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15495 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15496 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15497 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15498 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15499 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15500 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15501 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015502 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15503
15504crc32c([<avalanche>])
15505 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15506 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15507 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15508 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15509 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15510 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15511 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15512 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015513
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015514cut_crlf
15515 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15516 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15517 updated.
15518
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015519da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015520 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15521 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15522 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15523 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015524 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015525 configuration language.
15526
15527 Example:
15528 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015529 bind *:8881
15530 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015531 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015532
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015533debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15534 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15535 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15536 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15537 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15538 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15539 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15540 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15541 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15542 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15543 printable sample types.
15544
15545 Example:
15546 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015547
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015548digest(<algorithm>)
15549 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15550 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15551
15552 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15553 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15554
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015555div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015556 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15557 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015558 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015559 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15560 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015561 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015562 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15563 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15564 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15565 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015566 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015567 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015568
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015569djb2([<avalanche>])
15570 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15571 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15572 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15573 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15574 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15575 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15576 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015577 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15578 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015579
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015580even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015581 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015582 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15583
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015584field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15585 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15586 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15587 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15588 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15589 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15590 fields.
15591
15592 Example :
15593 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15594 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15595 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15596 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15597 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015598
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015599fix_is_valid
15600 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
15601 Information eXchange):
15602
15603 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
15604 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050015605 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015606 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
15607 - checks the MstType tag is the third tag.
15608 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
15609 checksum
15610
15611 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15612 the server can be parsed.
15613
15614 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
15615 message, false if not.
15616
15617 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
15618
15619 Example:
15620 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15621 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15622
15623fix_tag_value(<tag>)
15624 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
15625 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
15626 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
15627 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
15628 MsgType, SenderComID, TargetComID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
15629 added.
15630
15631 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15632 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
15633 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
15634 fix_is_valid converter.
15635
15636 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
15637
15638 Example:
15639 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15640 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15641 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
15642 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
15643 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
15644
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015645hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015646 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015647 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015648 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015649 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015650
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015651hex2i
15652 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015653 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015654
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015655htonl
15656 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15657 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15658 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15659 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15660
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010015661hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015662 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15663 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15664 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15665 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15666
15667 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15668 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15669
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015670http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015671 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15672 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015673 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15674 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15675 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15676 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15677 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15678 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15679 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15680 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015681
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015682iif(<true>,<false>)
15683 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15684 string otherwise.
15685
15686 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015687 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015688
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015689in_table(<table>)
15690 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15691 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15692 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015693 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015694 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15695
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010015696ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015697 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015698 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015699 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15700 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15701 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15702 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15703 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015704
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015705json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015706 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015707 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015708 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015709 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15710 of errors:
15711 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15712 bytes, ...)
15713 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15714 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15715
15716 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15717 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15718 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15719 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15720 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15721 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015722 - "ascii" : never fails;
15723 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15724 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015725 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015726 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015727 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15728 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15729
15730 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015731 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015732
15733 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015734 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015735 capture request header user-agent len 150
15736 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015737
15738 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15739 GET / HTTP/1.0
15740 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15741
15742 Output log:
15743 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15744
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015745language(<value>[,<default>])
15746 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15747 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15748 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15749 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15750 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15751 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15752 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15753 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15754 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015755 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015756 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15757 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015758
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015759 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015760
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015761 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15762 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015763
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015764 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15765 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15766 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15767 use_backend spanish if es
15768 use_backend french if fr
15769 use_backend english if en
15770 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015771
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015772length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015773 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15774 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15775 type. The result is of type integer.
15776
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015777lower
15778 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15779 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15780 type. The result is of type string.
15781
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015782ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15783 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15784 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15785 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15786 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15787 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15788 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15789
15790 Example :
15791
15792 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015793 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015794 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15795
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015796ltrim(<chars>)
15797 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15798 representation of the input sample.
15799
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015800map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15801map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15802map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15803 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15804 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15805 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15806 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15807 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15808 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15809 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15810 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015811
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015812 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15813 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15814 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015815
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015816 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015817 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015818
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015819 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15820 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15821 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15822 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015823 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15824 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015825 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15826 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15827 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15828 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15829 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15830 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15831 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15832 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015833 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15834 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15835 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015836 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15837 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15838 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15839 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15840 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015841
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015842 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15843 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15844 the corresponding match text.
15845
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015846 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15847 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15848 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15849 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15850 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015851
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015852 Example :
15853
15854 # this is a comment and is ignored
15855 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15856 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15857 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15858 | | | `---------- value
15859 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15860 | `---------------------------- key
15861 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15862
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015863mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015864 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15865 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015866 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015867 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015868 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015869 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15870 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15871 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15872 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015873 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015874 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015875
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010015876mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname or property ID>)
15877 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
15878 <packettype>.
15879 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
15880 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
15881 from.
15882 Supported string and integers can be found here:
15883 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
15884 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
15885
15886 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
15887 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
15888 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
15889 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
15890
15891 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
15892 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
15893 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15894 packets only):
15895 17: Session Expiry Interval
15896 33: Receive Maximum
15897 39: Maximum Packet Size
15898 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15899 25: Request Response Information
15900 23: Request Problem Information
15901 21: Authentication Method
15902 22: Authentication Data
15903 18: Will Delay Interval
15904 1: Payload Format Indicator
15905 2: Message Expiry Interval
15906 3: Content Type
15907 8: Response Topic
15908 9: Correlation Data
15909 Not supported yet:
15910 38: User Property
15911
15912 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
15913 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15914 packets only):
15915 17: Session Expiry Interval
15916 33: Receive Maximum
15917 36: Maximum QoS
15918 37: Retain Available
15919 39: Maximum Packet Size
15920 18: Assigned Client Identifier
15921 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15922 31: Reason String
15923 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
15924 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
15925 42: Shared Subscription Available
15926 19: Server Keep Alive
15927 26: Response Information
15928 28: Server Reference
15929 21: Authentication Method
15930 22: Authentication Data
15931 Not supported yet:
15932 38: User Property
15933
15934 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15935 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15936 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15937 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15938
15939 Example:
15940
15941 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15942 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15943 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
15944 if data_in_buffer
15945 # do the same as above
15946 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15947 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
15948 if data_in_buffer
15949
15950mqtt_is_valid
15951 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
15952
15953 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15954 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15955 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15956 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15957
15958 Example:
15959
15960 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15961 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
15962
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015963mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015964 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015965 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15966 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015967 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015968 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015969 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015970 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15971 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15972 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15973 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015974 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015975 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015976
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015977nbsrv
15978 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15979 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15980 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15981 map lookup.
15982
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015983neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015984 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15985 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15986 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15987 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015988
15989not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015990 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015991 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015992 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015993 absence of a flag).
15994
15995odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015996 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015997 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15998
15999or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016000 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016001 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016002 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16003 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016004 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016005 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16006 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16007 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16008 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016009 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016010 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016011
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016012protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16013 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16014 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16015 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16016 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16017 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16018 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16019 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16020 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16021 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16022 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16023 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16024
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016025regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016026 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16027 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16028 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16029 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16030 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16031 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16032 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16033 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16034 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016035 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16036 of characters with other ones.
16037
16038 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16039 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16040 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16041 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16042 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16043 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016044
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016045 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016046
16047 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16048 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16049 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016050 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016051
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016052 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16053 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16054
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016055 # capture groups and backreferences
16056 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016057 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016058 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16059
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016060capture-req(<id>)
16061 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16062 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16063
16064 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016065 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16066 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016067
16068capture-res(<id>)
16069 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16070 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16071
16072 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016073 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16074 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016075
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016076rtrim(<chars>)
16077 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16078 of the input sample.
16079
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016080sdbm([<avalanche>])
16081 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16082 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16083 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16084 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16085 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16086 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16087 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016088 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16089 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016090
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016091secure_memcmp(<var>)
16092 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16093 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16094 match.
16095
16096 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16097 performed in constant time.
16098
16099 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16100 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16101
16102 Example :
16103
16104 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16105 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16106 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16107 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16108
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016109set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016110 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16111 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16112 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016113 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016114 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16115 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016116 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016117 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16118 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016119 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016120 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016121
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016122sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016123 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016124 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16125
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016126sha2([<bits>])
16127 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16128 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16129
16130 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16131 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16132
16133 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16134 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16135
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016136srv_queue
16137 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16138 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16139 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16140 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16141 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16142
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016143strcmp(<var>)
16144 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16145 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16146 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16147 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16148 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16149 shorter).
16150
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016151 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16152 strings in constant time.
16153
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016154 Example :
16155
16156 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16157 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16158 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16159
16160
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016161sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016162 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16163 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016164 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016165 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16166 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016167 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016168 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16169 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016170 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016171 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16172 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016173 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016174 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016175
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016176table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16177 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16178 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16179 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16180 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16181 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16182 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16183
16184
16185table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16186 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16187 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16188 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16189 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16190 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16191 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16192
16193table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16194 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16195 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016196 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016197 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16198 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16199
16200table_conn_cur(<table>)
16201 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16202 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16203 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16204 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16205 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16206
16207table_conn_rate(<table>)
16208 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16209 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16210 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16211 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16212 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16213
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016214table_gpt0(<table>)
16215 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16216 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16217 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16218 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16219 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16220
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016221table_gpc0(<table>)
16222 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16223 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16224 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16225 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16226 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16227
16228table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16229 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16230 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16231 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16232 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16233 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16234 sample fetch keyword.
16235
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016236table_gpc1(<table>)
16237 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16238 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16239 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16240 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16241 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16242
16243table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16244 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16245 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16246 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16247 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16248 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16249 sample fetch keyword.
16250
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016251table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16252 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16253 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016254 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016255 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16256 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16257
16258table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16259 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16260 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16261 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16262 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16263 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16264 keyword.
16265
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016266table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16267 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16268 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16269 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16270 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16271 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16272
16273table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16274 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16275 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16276 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16277 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16278 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16279 keyword.
16280
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016281table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16282 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16283 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016284 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016285 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16286 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16287
16288table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16289 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16290 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16291 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16292 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16293 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16294 keyword.
16295
16296table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16297 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16298 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016299 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016300 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16301 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16302 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16303 keyword.
16304
16305table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16306 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16307 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016308 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016309 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16310 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16311 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16312 keyword.
16313
16314table_server_id(<table>)
16315 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16316 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16317 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16318 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16319 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16320 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16321
16322table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16323 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16324 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016325 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016326 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16327 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16328 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16329 keyword.
16330
16331table_sess_rate(<table>)
16332 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16333 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16334 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16335 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16336 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16337 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16338 keyword.
16339
16340table_trackers(<table>)
16341 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16342 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16343 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16344 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16345 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16346 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16347 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16348 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16349 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16350 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16351
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016352upper
16353 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16354 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16355 type. The result is of type string.
16356
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016357url_dec([<in_form>])
16358 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16359 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16360 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16361 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16362 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16363 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016364
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016365url_enc([<enc_type>])
16366 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16367 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16368 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16369 optional argument is here for future changes.
16370
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016371ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016372 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016373 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16374 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16375 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016376 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16377 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16378 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16379 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016380 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016381 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16382 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016383
16384 Example:
16385 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16386 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16387
16388 message Point {
16389 int32 latitude = 1;
16390 int32 longitude = 2;
16391 }
16392
16393 message PPoint {
16394 Point point = 59;
16395 }
16396
16397 message Rectangle {
16398 // One corner of the rectangle.
16399 PPoint lo = 48;
16400 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16401 PPoint hi = 49;
16402 }
16403
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016404 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16405 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16406 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016407
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016408 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16409 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016410 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016411 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16412
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016413 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016414
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016415 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016416
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016417 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16418 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16419 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016420
16421 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16422 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16423 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16424
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016425 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16426 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16427 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016428
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016429
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016430unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016431 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16432 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16433 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16434 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16435 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16436 response),
16437 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16438 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16439 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16440 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16441
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016442utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16443 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16444 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16445 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16446 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16447 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16448 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16449
16450 Example :
16451
16452 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016453 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016454 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16455
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016456word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16457 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16458 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16459 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016460 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016461 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16462 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16463
16464 Example :
16465 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16466 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16467 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16468 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16469 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016470 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016471
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016472wt6([<avalanche>])
16473 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16474 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16475 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16476 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16477 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16478 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16479 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016480 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16481 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016482
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016483xor(<value>)
16484 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016485 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016486 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016487 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016488 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016489 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16490 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016491 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016492 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16493 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016494 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016495 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016496
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010016497xxh3([<seed>])
16498 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
16499 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
16500 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
16501 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
16502 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
16503 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
16504 considered as cryptographically secure.
16505
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016506xxh32([<seed>])
16507 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16508 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16509 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16510 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16511 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16512 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16513 as cryptographically secure.
16514
16515xxh64([<seed>])
16516 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16517 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16518 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16519 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16520 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16521 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16522 as cryptographically secure.
16523
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016524
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200165257.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016526--------------------------------------------
16527
16528A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16529not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16530"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16531The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16532
16533always_false : boolean
16534 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16535 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16536
16537always_true : boolean
16538 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16539 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16540
16541avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016542 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016543 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16544 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16545 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16546 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16547 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16548 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16549 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16550 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16551 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16552 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16553 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16554 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16555 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016557be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016558 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16559 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16560 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16561 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016562 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16563
16564be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16565 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16566 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16567 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16568 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16569 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016570 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16571 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016572
16573 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16574 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16575 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016577be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16578 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16579 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16580 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016581 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016582 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16583 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016584
16585 Example :
16586 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16587 backend dynamic
16588 mode http
16589 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16590 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016591
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016592bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016593 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16594 of the string.
16595
16596bool(<bool>) : bool
16597 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16598 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016600connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16601 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016602 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016603 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16604 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016605
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016606 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016607 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016608 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
16609
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016610 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
16611 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016612
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016613 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016614 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016615 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016616 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016617 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016618 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016619 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016620
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016621 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16622 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016623 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016624 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016625
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016626cpu_calls : integer
16627 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16628 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16629 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16630 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16631 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16632 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16633
16634cpu_ns_avg : integer
16635 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16636 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16637 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16638 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16639 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16640 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16641 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16642 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16643 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16644 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16645 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16646
16647cpu_ns_tot : integer
16648 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16649 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16650 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16651 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16652 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16653 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16654 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16655 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16656 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16657 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16658 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16659 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16660 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16661
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016662date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016663 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016664
16665 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16666 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16667 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016668 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16669
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016670 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16671 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16672 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16673 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16674 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16675
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016676 Example :
16677
16678 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16679 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016680
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016681 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16682 # millisecond granularity
16683 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16684
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016685date_us : integer
16686 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16687 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16688 from the same timeval structure.
16689
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016690distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16691 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16692 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16693 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16694 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16695 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16696 list of supported tokens.
16697
16698distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16699 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16700 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16701 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16702 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16703 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16704 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16705 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16706 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16707 supported tokens.
16708
16709 Example :
16710 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16711 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16712 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16713 # send large files to the big farm
16714 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16715
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016716env(<name>) : string
16717 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16718 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16719 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16720 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16721 certain way.
16722
16723 Examples :
16724 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16725 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16726
16727 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16728 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016730fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16731 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016732 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16733 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016734 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16735 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016736 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016737 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16738 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016739
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016740fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16741 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16742 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16743 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016745fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16746 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16747 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16748 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16749 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16750 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16751 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16752 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16753 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016754
16755 Example :
16756 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16757 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16758 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16759 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16760 frontend mail
16761 bind :25
16762 mode tcp
16763 maxconn 100
16764 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16765 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16766 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16767 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016768
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016769hostname : string
16770 Returns the system hostname.
16771
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016772int(<integer>) : signed integer
16773 Returns a signed integer.
16774
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016775ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16776 Returns an ipv4.
16777
16778ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16779 Returns an ipv6.
16780
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016781lat_ns_avg : integer
16782 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16783 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16784 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16785 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16786 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16787 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16788 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16789 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16790 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016791 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16792 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16793 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16794 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16795 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16796 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016797
16798lat_ns_tot : integer
16799 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16800 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16801 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16802 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16803 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16804 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16805 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16806 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16807 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016808 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16809 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16810 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16811 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16812 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016813 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16814 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16815 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16816 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16817 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16818 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16819
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016820meth(<method>) : method
16821 Returns a method.
16822
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016823nbproc : integer
16824 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16825 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16826 and debugging purposes.
16827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016828nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16829 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16830 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16831 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016832 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16833 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16834 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016835
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016836prio_class : integer
16837 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16838 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16839 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16840
16841prio_offset : integer
16842 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16843 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16844 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16845 set-priority-offset".
16846
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016847proc : integer
16848 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16849 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16850 debugging purposes.
16851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016852queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016853 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16854 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16855 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016856 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16857 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16858 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16859 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16860 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16861
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016862rand([<range>]) : integer
16863 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16864 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16865 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16866 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16867 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16868
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016869uuid([<version>]) : string
16870 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16871 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16872 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016874srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16875 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16876 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16877 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16878 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16879 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016880 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16881 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16882
16883srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16884 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16885 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16886 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16887 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16888 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16889 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16890 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16891
16892 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16893 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016894
16895srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16896 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16897 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16898 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016899 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016900 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16901 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16902 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16903
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016904srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16905 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16906 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16907 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16908 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16909 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16910 fetch methods.
16911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016912srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16913 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16914 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016915 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016916 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16917 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016918 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016919 overloading servers).
16920
16921 Example :
16922 # Redirect to a separate back
16923 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16924 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16925 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16926
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016927srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16928 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16929 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16930 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16931
16932srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16933 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16934 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16935 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16936
16937srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16938 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16939 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16940 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16941
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016942stopping : boolean
16943 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16944 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16945 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16946
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016947str(<string>) : string
16948 Returns a string.
16949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016950table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16951 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16952 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16953
16954table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16955 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16956 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16957 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16958
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016959thread : integer
16960 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16961 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16962 and debugging purposes.
16963
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016964var(<var-name>) : undefined
16965 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016966 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16967 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016968 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016969 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16970 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016971 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016972 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16973 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016974 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016975 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016976
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200169777.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016978----------------------------------
16979
16980The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16981closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16982methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16983sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16984TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016985the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16986counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016987"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16988used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16989can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16990Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16991table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16992tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16993currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016994
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016995bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016996 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16997 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16998 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017000be_id : integer
17001 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017002 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17003 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017004
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017005be_name : string
17006 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017007 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17008 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017009
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017010be_server_timeout : integer
17011 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17012 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17013 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17014
17015be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17016 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17017 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17018 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17019
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017020cur_server_timeout : integer
17021 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17022 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17023 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17024
17025cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17026 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17027 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17028 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017030dst : ip
17031 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17032 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17033 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17034 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017035 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17036 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17037 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17038 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17039 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17040 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017041
17042dst_conn : integer
17043 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17044 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17045 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17046 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17047 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17048 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17049 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17050 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017051
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017052dst_is_local : boolean
17053 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17054 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17055 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17056 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017057 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017058 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17059 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17060 it only once per connection.
17061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017062dst_port : integer
17063 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17064 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17065 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17066 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17067 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17068 an HTTP header.
17069
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017070fc_http_major : integer
17071 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17072 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17073 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17074
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017075fc_pp_authority : string
17076 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17077 if any.
17078
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017079fc_pp_unique_id : string
17080 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17081 if any.
17082
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017083fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17084 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17085 header.
17086
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017087fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17088 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17089 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17090 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17091 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17092 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17093 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17094
17095fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17096 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17097 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17098 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17099 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17100 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17101 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17102
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017103fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017104 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17105 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17106 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17107 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17108
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017109fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017110 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17111 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17112 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17113 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17114
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017115fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017116 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17117 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17118 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17119 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17120
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017121fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017122 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17123 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17124 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17125 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17126
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017127fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017128 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17129 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17130 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17131 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17132
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017133fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017134 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17135 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17136 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17137 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17138
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017139fe_defbe : string
17140 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17141 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017143fe_id : integer
17144 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017145 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017146 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17147
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017148fe_name : string
17149 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17150 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17151 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17152
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017153fe_client_timeout : integer
17154 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17155 current frontend.
17156
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017157sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017158sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17159sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17160sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017161 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17162 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17163 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17164
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017165sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017166sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17167sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17168sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017169 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17170 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17171 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17172
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017173sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017174sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17175sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17176sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017177 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17178 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017179 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17180 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17181 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017182
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017183 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017184 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17185 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017186 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17187 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17188 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017189 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17190 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17191
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017192sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17193sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17194sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17195sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17196 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17197 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17198 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17199 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17200 when a first ACL was verified.
17201
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017202sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017203sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17204sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17205sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017206 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017207 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17208
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017209sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017210sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17211sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17212sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017213 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17214 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17215 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17216
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017217sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017218sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17219sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17220sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017221 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17222 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17223 See also src_conn_rate.
17224
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017225sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017226sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17227sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17228sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017229 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017230 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017231
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017232sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17233sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17234sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17235sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17236 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17237 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17238
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017239sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17240sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17241sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17242sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17243 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17244 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17245
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017246sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017247sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17248sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17249sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017250 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17251 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17252 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017253 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17254 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17255 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017256
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017257sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17258sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17259sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17260sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17261 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17262 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17263 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17264 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17265 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17266 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17267
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017268sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017269sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17270sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17271sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017272 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017273 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17274 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17275
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017276sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017277sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17278sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17279sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017280 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17281 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17282 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17283 src_http_err_rate.
17284
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017285sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17286sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17287sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17288sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17289 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17290 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17291 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17292
17293sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17294sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17295sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17296sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17297 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
17298 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
17299 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
17300 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
17301
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017302sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017303sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17304sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17305sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017306 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017307 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17308 src_http_req_cnt.
17309
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017310sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017311sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17312sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17313sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017314 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17315 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17316 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17317 src_http_req_rate.
17318
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017319sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017320sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17321sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17322sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017323 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017324 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17325 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17326 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17327 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017328
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017329 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017330 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17331 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017332 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17333
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017334sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17335sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17336sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17337sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17338 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17339 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17340 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17341 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17342 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17343
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017344sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017345sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17346sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17347sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017348 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17349 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17350 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017351
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017352sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017353sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17354sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17355sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017356 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17357 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17358 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017359
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017360sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017361sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17362sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17363sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017364 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017365 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17366 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17367 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017368 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017369 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17370
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017371sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017372sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17373sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17374sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017375 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17376 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17377 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17378 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17379 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017380 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017381
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017382sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017383sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17384sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17385sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017386 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17387 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17388 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17389
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017390sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017391sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17392sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17393sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017394 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17395 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017396 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017397 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17398 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017399 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17400 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17401 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017403so_id : integer
17404 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17405 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17406 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017407
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017408so_name : string
17409 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17410 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17411 strings instead of integers.
17412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017413src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017414 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017415 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17416 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17417 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017418 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17419 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17420 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017421 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17422 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17423 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17424 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17425 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17426 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17427 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017428
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017429 Example:
17430 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17431 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017433src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17434 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17435 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17436 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017437 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017439src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17440 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17441 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017442 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017443 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017445src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17446 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17447 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17448 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17449 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17450 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17451 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017452
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017453 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017454 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17455 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17456 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17457 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017458 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017459 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17460 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17461
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017462src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17463 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17464 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17465 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17466 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17467 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17468 was verified.
17469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017470src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017471 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017472 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017473 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017474 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017476src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017477 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017478 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17479 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017480 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017482src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17483 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17484 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17485 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017486 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017488src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017489 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017490 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017491 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017492 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017493
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017494src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17495 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17496 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17497 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17498 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
17499
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017500src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17501 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17502 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17503 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17504 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
17505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017506src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017507 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017508 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017509 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17510 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017511 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17512 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17513 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017514
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017515src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17516 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17517 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17518 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17519 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17520 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17521 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17522 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017524src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017525 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017526 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017527 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017528 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017529 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017531src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17532 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17533 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17534 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17535 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017536 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017537
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017538src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17539 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
17540 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17541 the designated stick-table. This includes the both repsonse errors and 5xx
17542 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
17543 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17544
17545src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17546 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
17547 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17548 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
17549 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
17550 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
17551 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
17552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017553src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017554 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017555 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17556 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017557 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017559src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17560 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17561 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17562 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017563 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017564 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017566src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17567 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17568 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17569 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017570 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017571 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17572 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017573
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017574 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017575 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017576 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017577 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017578
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017579src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17580 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17581 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17582 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17583 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17584 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17585 connection when a first ACL was verified.
17586
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017587src_is_local : boolean
17588 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
17589 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
17590 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
17591 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017592 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017593 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
17594 once per connection.
17595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017596src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017597 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
17598 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
17599 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
17600 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
17601 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017603src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017604 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
17605 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17606 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
17607 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
17608 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017610src_port : integer
17611 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17612 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
17613 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
17614 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017616src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017617 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017618 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17619 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
17620 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017621 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017623src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17624 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
17625 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17626 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17627 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017628 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017630src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17631 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
17632 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
17633 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
17634 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
17635 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
17636 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
17637 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
17638 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017639
17640 Example :
17641 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
17642 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
17643 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
17644 listen ssh
17645 bind :22
17646 mode tcp
17647 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017648 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017649 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017650 server local 127.0.0.1:22
17651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017652srv_id : integer
17653 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
17654 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017655 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020017656
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017657srv_name : string
17658 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
17659 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017660 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017661
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200176627.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017663----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020017664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017665The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
17666closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
17667when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
17668usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017669future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017670
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001767151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
17672 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17673 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17674 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
17675 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17676 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17677
17678 Example :
17679 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
17680 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
17681 # the request.
17682 frontend http-in
17683 bind *:8081
17684 default_backend servers
17685 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17686 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17687
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017688ssl_bc : boolean
17689 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17690 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017691 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17692 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017693
17694ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
17695 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017696 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17697 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017698
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017699ssl_bc_alpn : string
17700 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
17701 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017702 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017703 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17704 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17705 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
17706 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
17707 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017708 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
17709 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017710
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017711ssl_bc_cipher : string
17712 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017713 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17714 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017715
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017716ssl_bc_client_random : binary
17717 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17718 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17719 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017720 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017721
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017722ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17723 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17724 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017725 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17726 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017727
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017728ssl_bc_npn : string
17729 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17730 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017731 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017732 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17733 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17734 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17735 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017736 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17737 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017738
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017739ssl_bc_protocol : string
17740 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017741 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17742 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017743
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017744ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017745 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017746 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017747 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17748 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017749
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017750ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17751 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17752 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17753 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017754 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017755
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017756ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17757 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17758 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017759 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17760 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017761
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017762ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17763 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17764 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17765 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017766 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017767
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017768ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17769 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017770 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17771 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017773ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17774 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17775 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17776 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17777 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17778 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017780ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17781 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17782 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17783 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17784 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017785
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017786ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017787 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17788 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17789 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050017790 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017791 does not support resumed sessions.
17792
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017793ssl_c_der : binary
17794 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17795 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17796 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017798ssl_c_err : integer
17799 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17800 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17801 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17802 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17803 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017804
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017805ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017806 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17807 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17808 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17809 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17810 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17811 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17812 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17813 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017814 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17815 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17816 LDAP v3.
17817 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17818 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017820ssl_c_key_alg : string
17821 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17822 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17823 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017825ssl_c_notafter : string
17826 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17827 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17828 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017830ssl_c_notbefore : string
17831 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17832 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17833 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017834
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017835ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017836 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17837 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17838 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17839 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17840 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17841 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17842 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17843 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017844 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17845 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17846 LDAP v3.
17847 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17848 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017850ssl_c_serial : binary
17851 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17852 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17853 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017855ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17856 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17857 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17858 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017859 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17860 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17861
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017862 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017863 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017865ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17866 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17867 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17868 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017870ssl_c_used : boolean
17871 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17872 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017874ssl_c_verify : integer
17875 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17876 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17877 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17878 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017880ssl_c_version : integer
17881 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17882 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017883
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017884ssl_f_der : binary
17885 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17886 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17887 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17888
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017889ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017890 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17891 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17892 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17893 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017894 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017895 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17896 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17897 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017898 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17899 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17900 LDAP v3.
17901 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17902 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017904ssl_f_key_alg : string
17905 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17906 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17907 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017909ssl_f_notafter : string
17910 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17911 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17912 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017914ssl_f_notbefore : string
17915 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17916 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17917 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017918
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017919ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017920 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17921 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17922 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17923 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17924 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17925 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17926 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17927 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017928 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17929 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17930 LDAP v3.
17931 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17932 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017934ssl_f_serial : binary
17935 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17936 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17937 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017938
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017939ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17940 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17941 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17942 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017944ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17945 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17946 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17947 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017949ssl_f_version : integer
17950 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17951 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17952
17953ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017954 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17955 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17956 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017958 Example :
17959 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17960 listen http-https
17961 bind :80
17962 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17963 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17964
17965ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17966 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17967 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17968
17969ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017970 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017971 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17972 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17973 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17974 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17975 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17976 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17977 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17978 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017980ssl_fc_cipher : string
17981 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17982 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017983
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017984ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17985 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17986 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017987 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017988
17989ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17990 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17991 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017992 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017993
17994ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17995 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17996 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17997 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017998 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017999 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018000
18001ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18002 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18003 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018004 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018005
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018006ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18007 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18008 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18009 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18010
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018011ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18012 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18013 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18014 transport layer.
18015 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18016 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18017 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18018 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18019
18020ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18021 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18022 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18023 transport layer.
18024 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18025 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18026 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18027 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18028
18029ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18030 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18031 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18032 transport layer.
18033 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18034 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18035 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18036 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18037
18038ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18039 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18040 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18041 transport layer.
18042 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18043 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18044 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18045 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18046
18047ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18048 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18049 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18050 transport layer.
18051 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18052 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18053 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18054 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018056ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018057 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18058 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018059 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18060 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18061 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18062 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018063
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018064ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18065 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18066 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18067 wait until the handshake happened.
18068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018069ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18070 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018071 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18072 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018073 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018074 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018075
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018076ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018077 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018078 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18079 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018081ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018082 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018083 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
18084 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18085 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18086 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18087 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18088 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18089 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018091ssl_fc_protocol : string
18092 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18093 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018094
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018095ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018096 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018097 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18098 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018099
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018100ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18101 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18102 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18103 transport layer.
18104 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18105 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18106 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18107 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18108
18109ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18110 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18111 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18112 transport layer.
18113 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18114 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18115 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18116 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18117
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018118ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18119 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18120 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18121 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018123ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18124 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18125 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18126 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18127 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018128
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018129ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18130 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18131 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18132 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18133 BoringSSL.
18134
18135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018136ssl_fc_sni : string
18137 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18138 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
18139 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
18140 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18141 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18142
18143 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
18144 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
18145 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018146 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018147 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018149 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018150 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18151 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018153ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18154 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18155 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018156
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018157ssl_s_der : binary
18158 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18159 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18160 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18161
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018162ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18163 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18164 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18165 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018166 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018167 does not support resumed sessions.
18168
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018169ssl_s_key_alg : string
18170 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18171 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18172 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18173
18174ssl_s_notafter : string
18175 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18176 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18177 transport layer.
18178
18179ssl_s_notbefore : string
18180 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18181 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18182 transport layer.
18183
18184ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18185 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18186 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18187 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18188 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18189 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18190 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018191 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18192 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018193 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18194 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18195 LDAP v3.
18196 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18197 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18198
18199ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18200 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18201 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18202 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18203 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18204 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18205 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018206 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18207 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018208 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18209 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18210 LDAP v3.
18211 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18212 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18213
18214ssl_s_serial : binary
18215 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18216 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18217 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18218
18219ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18220 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18221 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18222 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18223
18224ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18225 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18226 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18227 layer.
18228
18229ssl_s_version : integer
18230 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18231 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018232
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200182337.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018234------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018236Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18237sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18238only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18239For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18240be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18241can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18242sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18243for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18244content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018246payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018247 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018248 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18249 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018251payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18252 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018253 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018254 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018256req.len : integer
18257req_len : integer (deprecated)
18258 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18259 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18260 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18261 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18262 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18263 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18264 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18265 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018267req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18268 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018269 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18270 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18271 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18272 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018274 ACL alternatives :
18275 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018277req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18278 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18279 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18280 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18281 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018283 ACL alternatives :
18284 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018286 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018288req.proto_http : boolean
18289req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18290 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18291 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18292 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18293 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18294 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18295 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18296 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018298 Example:
18299 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18300 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18301 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018302 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018304req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18305rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18306 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18307 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18308 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18309 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18310 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18311 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18312 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018314 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18315 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18316 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18317 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18318 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18319 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018321 ACL derivatives :
18322 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018324 Example :
18325 listen tse-farm
18326 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18327 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18328 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18329 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18330 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18331 persist rdp-cookie
18332 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18333 # This is only useful makes sense if
18334 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18335 stick-table type string size 204800
18336 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18337 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18338 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018340 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18341 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018343req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18344rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18345 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18346 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18347 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18348 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018350 ACL derivatives :
18351 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018352
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018353req.ssl_alpn : string
18354 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18355 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18356 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18357 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18358 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18359 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018360 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018361
18362 Examples :
18363 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18364 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18365 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018366 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018367 default_backend bk_default
18368
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018369req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18370 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18371 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018372 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18373 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18374 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18375 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18376 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018378req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18379req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18380 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18381 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18382 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18383 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18384 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18385 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18386 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018388req.ssl_sni : string
18389req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18390 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18391 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18392 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18393 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18394 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018395 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18396 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18397 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18398 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18399 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18400 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18401 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18402 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18403 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018405 ACL derivatives :
18406 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018408 Examples :
18409 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18410 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18411 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18412 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18413 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018414
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018415req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18416 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18417 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18418 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18419 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18420 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18421 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18422 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18423 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18424 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018426req.ssl_ver : integer
18427req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18428 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18429 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18430 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18431 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18432 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18433 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18434 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018435 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018436 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018438 ACL derivatives :
18439 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018440
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018441res.len : integer
18442 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18443 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18444 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18445 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18446 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18447 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18448 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018449 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018451res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18452 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018453 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018454 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018455 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018456 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018458res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18459 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18460 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18461 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018462 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18463 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018465 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018466
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018467res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18468rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18469 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18470 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18471 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18472 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18473 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18474 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18475 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018477wait_end : boolean
18478 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18479 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018480 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018481 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18482 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018483 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018484 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18485 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018487 Examples :
18488 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18489 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18490 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018492 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
18493 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18494 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
18495 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
18496 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
18497 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
18498 tcp-request content reject
18499
18500
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200185017.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018502--------------------------------------
18503
18504It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18505This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18506data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18507its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18508HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18509content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18510to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18511more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18512response are indexed.
18513
18514base : string
18515 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18516 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18517 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18518 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18519 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18520 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18521 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18522 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18523
18524 ACL derivatives :
18525 base : exact string match
18526 base_beg : prefix match
18527 base_dir : subdir match
18528 base_dom : domain match
18529 base_end : suffix match
18530 base_len : length match
18531 base_reg : regex match
18532 base_sub : substring match
18533
18534base32 : integer
18535 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18536 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18537 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018538 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18539 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18540 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018541
18542base32+src : binary
18543 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18544 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18545 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18546 per-URL counters.
18547
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010018548baseq : string
18549 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18550 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
18551 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
18552 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
18553
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018554capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18555 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18556 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18557 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18558
18559capture.req.method : string
18560 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18561 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18562 because it's allocated.
18563
18564capture.req.uri : string
18565 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18566 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18567 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18568 allocated.
18569
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018570capture.req.ver : string
18571 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18572 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
18573 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
18574
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018575capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
18576 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
18577 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18578 The first entry is an index of 0.
18579 See also: "capture response header"
18580
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018581capture.res.ver : string
18582 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18583 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
18584 persistent flag.
18585
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018586req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018587 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
18588 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
18589 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018590
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020018591req.body_param([<name>) : string
18592 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
18593 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
18594 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
18595 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
18596 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
18597 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
18598 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
18599 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
18600 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
18601 given.
18602
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018603req.body_len : integer
18604 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
18605 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018606 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
18607 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018608
18609req.body_size : integer
18610 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018611 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18612 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018614req.cook([<name>]) : string
18615cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18616 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18617 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
18618 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
18619 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
18620 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
18621 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
18622 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
18623 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
18624
18625 ACL derivatives :
18626 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
18627 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
18628 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
18629 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
18630 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
18631 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
18632 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
18633 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018635req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18636cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18637 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18638 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018640req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18641cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18642 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18643 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
18644 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
18645 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018647cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18648 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18649 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
18650 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
18651 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018652 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018653 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
18654 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
18655 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
18656 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018658hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18659 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
18660 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
18661 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
18662 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018663 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018665req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018666 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
18667 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
18668 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
18669 with headers such as User-Agent.
18670
18671 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
18672 found.
18673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018674 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18675 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18676 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018677 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018679req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18680 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18681 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018682 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
18683 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018685req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018686 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
18687 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
18688 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
18689 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
18690 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
18691 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
18692 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
18693
18694 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
18695 found.
18696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018697 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18698 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18699 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018700 with -1 being the last one.
18701
18702 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
18703 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018705 ACL derivatives :
18706 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18707 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18708 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18709 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18710 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18711 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18712 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18713 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18714
18715req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18716hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18717 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18718 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018719 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
18720 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
18721 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
18722
18723 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
18724 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
18725 which contain more than one of certain headers.
18726
18727 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018728
18729req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18730hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18731 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18732 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18733 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018734 of every header is checked.
18735
18736 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
18737
18738 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018739
18740req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18741hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18742 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18743 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18744 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018745
18746 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
18747
18748 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018749
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018750req.hdrs : string
18751 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
18752 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18753 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18754 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
18755
18756req.hdrs_bin : binary
18757 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18758 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
18759 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
18760 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
18761 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
18762 names and values (length of 0 for both).
18763
18764 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018765
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018766 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18767 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018769http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18770 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18771 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18772 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18773 basic auth is supported.
18774
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018775http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18776 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18777 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18778 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18779 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018780 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18781 basic auth is supported.
18782
18783 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018784 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18785 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18786 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18787 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018788
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018789http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018790 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18791 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18792 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018793
18794http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018795 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18796 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18797 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018798
18799http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018800 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18801 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18802 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018804http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018805 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18806 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018807 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18808 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018810method : integer + string
18811 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18812 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18813 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18814 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18815 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18816 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18817 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018819 ACL derivatives :
18820 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018822 Example :
18823 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18824 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18825 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018827path : string
18828 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18829 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18830 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18831 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18832 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018833 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018834 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018836 ACL derivatives :
18837 path : exact string match
18838 path_beg : prefix match
18839 path_dir : subdir match
18840 path_dom : domain match
18841 path_end : suffix match
18842 path_len : length match
18843 path_reg : regex match
18844 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018845
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018846pathq : string
18847 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18848 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18849 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18850 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18851 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18852 result in both cases.
18853
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018854query : string
18855 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18856 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18857 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18858 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018859 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018860 which stops before the question mark.
18861
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018862req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18863 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18864 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18865 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18866 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018868req.ver : string
18869req_ver : string (deprecated)
18870 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18871 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18872 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018874 ACL derivatives :
18875 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018876
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018877res.body : binary
18878 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18879 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018880 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18881
18882 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018883
18884res.body_len : integer
18885 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18886 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018887 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18888
18889 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018890
18891res.body_size : integer
18892 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18893 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18894 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18895 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018896 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18897
18898 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018899
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010018900res.cache_hit : boolean
18901 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
18902 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
18903
18904res.cache_name : string
18905 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
18906 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
18907 empty string.
18908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018909res.comp : boolean
18910 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18911 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18912 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018914res.comp_algo : string
18915 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18916 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18917 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018919res.cook([<name>]) : string
18920scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18921 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18922 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018923 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
18924
18925 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018927 ACL derivatives :
18928 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018930res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18931scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18932 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18933 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018934 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
18935
18936 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018938res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18939scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18940 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18941 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018942 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
18943
18944 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018946res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018947 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
18948 on the headers within an HTTP response.
18949
18950 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
18951 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
18952
18953 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
18954
18955 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018957res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018958 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
18959 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18960
18961 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
18962 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
18963
18964 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018966res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18967shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018968 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
18969 on the headers within an HTTP response.
18970
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050018971 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018972 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
18973
18974 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018976 ACL derivatives :
18977 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18978 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18979 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18980 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18981 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18982 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18983 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18984 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18985
18986res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18987shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018988 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
18989 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18990
18991 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050018992 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018993
18994 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018996res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18997shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018998 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
18999 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19000
19001 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19002
19003 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019004
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019005res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19006 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19007 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19008 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019009 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19010
19011 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019013res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19014shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019015 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19016 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19017
19018 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19019
19020 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019021
19022res.hdrs : string
19023 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19024 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19025 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019026 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19027
19028 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019029
19030res.hdrs_bin : binary
19031 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19032 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19033 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19034 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19035 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19036 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19037 (length of 0 for both).
19038
19039 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19040
19041 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19042 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019044res.ver : string
19045resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19046 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019047 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19048
19049 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019051 ACL derivatives :
19052 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019054set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19055 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19056 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019057 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019058 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019060 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19061 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019063status : integer
19064 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19065 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019066 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19067
19068 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019069
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019070unique-id : string
19071 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19072 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19073 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19074 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19075 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19076 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019078url : string
19079 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19080 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19081 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19082 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19083 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19084 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19085 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019087 ACL derivatives :
19088 url : exact string match
19089 url_beg : prefix match
19090 url_dir : subdir match
19091 url_dom : domain match
19092 url_end : suffix match
19093 url_len : length match
19094 url_reg : regex match
19095 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019097url_ip : ip
19098 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19099 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19100 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19101 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19102 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19103 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19104 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019106url_port : integer
19107 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19108 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19109 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19110 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019111
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019112urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19113url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019114 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19115 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019116 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19117 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19118 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19119 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019120 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19121 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019122 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19123 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019125 ACL derivatives :
19126 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19127 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19128 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19129 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19130 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19131 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19132 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19133 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019134
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019136 Example :
19137 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19138 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19139 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19140 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019141
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019142urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019143 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19144 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19145 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019146
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019147url32 : integer
19148 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19149 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19150 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19151 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19152 is an unsigned integer.
19153
19154url32+src : binary
19155 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19156 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19157 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19158
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019159
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200191607.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019161---------------------------------------
19162
19163This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19164used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19165purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19166There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19167or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19168any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19169for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19170
19171internal.htx.data : integer
19172 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19173 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19174
19175internal.htx.free : integer
19176 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19177 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19178
19179internal.htx.free_data : integer
19180 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19181 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19182
19183internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019184 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19185 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19186 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019187
19188internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19189 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19190 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19191
19192internal.htx.size : integer
19193 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19194 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19195
19196internal.htx.used : integer
19197 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19198 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19199 direction.
19200
19201internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19202 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19203 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19204 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19205 of the special value :
19206 * head : The oldest inserted block
19207 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019208 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019209
19210internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19211 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19212 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19213 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19214 integer or one of the special value :
19215 * head : The oldest inserted block
19216 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019217 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019218
19219internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19220 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19221 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19222 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19223 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19224
19225 * head : The oldest inserted block
19226 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019227 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019228
19229internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19230 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19231 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19232 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19233 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19234
19235 * head : The oldest inserted block
19236 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019237 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019238
19239internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19240 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19241 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19242 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19243 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19244
19245 * head : The oldest inserted block
19246 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019247 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019248
19249internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19250 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19251 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19252 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19253 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19254
19255 * head : The oldest inserted block
19256 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019257 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019258
19259internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19260 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19261 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19262 it returns false.
19263
19264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200192657.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019266---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019267
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019268Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19269every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019270order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019272ACL name Equivalent to Usage
19273---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019274FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020019275HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019276HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
19277HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019278HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
19279HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19280HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19281HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19282LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019283METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020019284METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019285METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19286METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19287METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19288METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020019289METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019290METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020019291RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019292REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019293TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019294WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19295---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019296
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192988. Logging
19299----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019300
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019301One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19302provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19303very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19304provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19305state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019306to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019307headers.
19308
19309In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19310about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19311send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19312
19313 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19314 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19315 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19316 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19317 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019318 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019319 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019320
19321The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19322allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19323as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19324while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19325real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19326delay.
19327
19328
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193298.1. Log levels
19330---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019331
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019332TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019333source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019334HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19335in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19336track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19337syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19338about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019339
19340
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193418.2. Log formats
19342----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019343
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019344HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019345and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19346slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19347options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019348
19349 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19350 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19351 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19352 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19353 extents.
19354
19355 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19356 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19357 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19358 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19359 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19360
19361 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19362 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19363 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19364 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19365 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19366
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019367 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19368 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19369 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19370 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19371
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019372 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19373
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019374Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19375specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19376field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19377servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19378always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19379identifier.
19380
19381Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19382 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19383 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19384 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19385 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19386
19387
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193888.2.1. Default log format
19389-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019390
19391This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19392as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19393format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19394
19395 Example :
19396 listen www
19397 mode http
19398 log global
19399 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19400
19401 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19402 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19403 (www/HTTP)
19404
19405 Field Format Extract from the example above
19406 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19407 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19408 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19409 4 'to' to
19410 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19411 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19412
19413Detailed fields description :
19414 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19415 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19416 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19417 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19418 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19419 and processed the connection.
19420 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19421
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019422In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19423"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19424connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19425
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019426It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19427will eventually disappear.
19428
19429
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194308.2.2. TCP log format
19431---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019432
19433The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19434is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19435information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19436counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19437emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19438environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19439the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19440sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019441specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19442not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19443fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19444marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019445
19446 Example :
19447 frontend fnt
19448 mode tcp
19449 option tcplog
19450 log global
19451 default_backend bck
19452
19453 backend bck
19454 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19455
19456 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19457 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19458 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19459
19460 Field Format Extract from the example above
19461 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19462 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19463 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19464 4 frontend_name fnt
19465 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19466 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19467 7 bytes_read* 212
19468 8 termination_state --
19469 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19470 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19471
19472Detailed fields description :
19473 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019474 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19475 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19476 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019477 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019478 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019479 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019480
19481 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019482 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19483 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19484 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019485
19486 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
19487 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
19488 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019489 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
19490 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
19491 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
19492 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019493
19494 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19495 and processed the connection.
19496
19497 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19498 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19499 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
19500 applications.
19501
19502 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19503 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19504 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19505 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
19506 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
19507
19508 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19509 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
19510 See "Timers" below for more details.
19511
19512 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19513 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
19514 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
19515 "Timers" below for more details.
19516
19517 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019518 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019519 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
19520 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
19521 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
19522 details.
19523
19524 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
19525 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
19526 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
19527 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
19528 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
19529
19530 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19531 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19532 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
19533 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
19534 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
19535 for more details.
19536
19537 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019538 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019539 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
19540 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
19541 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019542 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019543
19544 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19545 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19546 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19547 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19548 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19549 caused by a denial of service attack.
19550
19551 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19552 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19553 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19554 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19555 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19556 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19557 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19558 denial of service attack.
19559
19560 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19561 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19562 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19563 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19564 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19565 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19566 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19567 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
19568 be processed than on other servers.
19569
19570 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19571 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19572 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19573 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19574 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19575 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19576 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19577 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19578 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19579 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19580 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19581 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19582 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19583
19584 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19585 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19586 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19587 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19588 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19589 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019590 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019591 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19592
19593 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19594 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19595 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19596 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19597 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19598 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019599 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019600 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19601 occurs.
19602
19603
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196048.2.3. HTTP log format
19605----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019606
19607The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
19608is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
19609the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
19610are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
19611emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
19612generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
19613"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
19614which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019615frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
19616is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019617
19618Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
19619slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
19620with a star ('*') after the field name below.
19621
19622 Example :
19623 frontend http-in
19624 mode http
19625 option httplog
19626 log global
19627 default_backend bck
19628
19629 backend static
19630 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19631
19632 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
19633 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
19634 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019635 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019636
19637 Field Format Extract from the example above
19638 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
19639 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019640 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019641 4 frontend_name http-in
19642 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019643 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019644 7 status_code 200
19645 8 bytes_read* 2750
19646 9 captured_request_cookie -
19647 10 captured_response_cookie -
19648 11 termination_state ----
19649 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
19650 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19651 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
19652 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
19653 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019654
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019655Detailed fields description :
19656 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019657 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19658 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19659 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019660 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019661 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019662 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019663
19664 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019665 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19666 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19667 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019668
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019669 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
19670 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019671
19672 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19673 and processed the connection.
19674
19675 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19676 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19677 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
19678
19679 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19680 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19681 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19682 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
19683 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
19684 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
19685
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019686 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
19687 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
19688 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019689 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019690 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
19691 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019692 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
19693 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019694
19695 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19696 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019697 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019698
19699 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19700 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019701 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
19702 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019703
19704 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
19705 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
19706 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
19707 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
19708 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019709 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
19710 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019711
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019712 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
19713 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
19714 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
19715 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
19716 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
19717 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
19718 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019719 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019720
19721 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
19722 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
19723 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
19724
19725 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
19726 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019727 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019728 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
19729 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
19730 overflowing.
19731
19732 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
19733 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
19734 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
19735 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
19736 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
19737 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
19738 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
19739 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19740
19741 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
19742 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
19743 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
19744 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
19745 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
19746 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
19747 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
19748 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19749
19750 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19751 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19752 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
19753 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19754 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19755 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19756 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19757
19758 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019759 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019760 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19761 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19762 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019763 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019764 system.
19765
19766 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19767 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19768 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19769 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19770 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19771 caused by a denial of service attack.
19772
19773 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19774 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19775 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19776 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19777 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19778 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19779 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19780 denial of service attack.
19781
19782 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19783 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19784 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19785 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19786 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19787 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19788 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19789 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19790 processed than on other servers.
19791
19792 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19793 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19794 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19795 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19796 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19797 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19798 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19799 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19800 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19801 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19802 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19803 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19804 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19805
19806 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19807 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19808 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19809 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19810 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19811 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019812 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019813 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19814
19815 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19816 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19817 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19818 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19819 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19820 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019821 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019822 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19823 occurs.
19824
19825 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19826 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19827 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19828 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19829 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19830 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19831 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19832 cookies" below for more details.
19833
19834 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19835 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19836 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19837 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19838 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19839 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19840 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19841 and cookies" below for more details.
19842
19843 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19844 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19845 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19846 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19847 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19848 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19849 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19850 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19851
19852
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200198538.2.4. Custom log format
19854------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019855
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019856The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019857mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019858
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019859HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019860Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19861separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19862prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19863
19864Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19865variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019866("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019867
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019868If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019869as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019870less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19871the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19872
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019873Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19874"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19875delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19876preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019877
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019878Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19879'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19880https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19881such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19882
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019883Flags are :
19884 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019885 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019886 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19887 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019888
19889 Example:
19890
19891 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19892 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19893
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019894 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19895
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019896At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19897
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019898 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19899 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019900
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019901the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019902
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019903 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19904 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19905 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019906
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019907and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19908
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019909 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19910 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019911
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019912Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19913
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019914 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019915 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019916 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19917 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19918 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019919 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19920 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19921 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019922 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019923 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000019924 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000019925 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019926 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019927 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19928 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019929 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019930 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019931 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019932 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019933 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019934 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019935 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019936 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19937 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19938 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19939 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19940 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019941 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019942 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019943 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019944 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019945 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019946 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19947 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019948 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19949 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19950 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019951 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019952 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19953 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019954 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019955 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19956 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19957 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019958 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019959 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019960 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19961 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19962 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19963 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019964 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019965 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019966 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019967 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019968 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019969 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019970 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19971 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19972 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019973 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019974 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19975 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019976 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019977 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19978 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019979 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019980 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019981 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019982 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019983
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019984 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019985
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019986
199878.2.5. Error log format
19988-----------------------
19989
19990When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19991protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19992By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19993"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019994will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019995logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19996
19997The format looks like this :
19998
19999 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20000 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20001 Connection error during SSL handshake
20002
20003 Field Format Extract from the example above
20004 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20005 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20006 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20007 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20008 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20009
20010These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20011failures.
20012
20013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200148.3. Advanced logging options
20015-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020016
20017Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20018just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20019options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20020for more information about their usage.
20021
20022
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200238.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20024------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020025
20026It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
20027haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
20028commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20029monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20030ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20031
20032 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20033 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20034 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20035 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20036
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020037 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20038 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020039
20040 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20041 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20042 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20043
20044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200458.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20046----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020047
20048The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20049what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20050or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020051"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020052just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20053log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20054after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20055is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20056with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20057with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20058
20059
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200608.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20061------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020062
20063Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20064for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20065"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20066retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20067raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20068a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20069file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20070you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20071"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20072
20073
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200748.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20075--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020076
20077Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20078multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20079them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20080"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20081logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20082error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20083and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20084too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20085useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20086alternative.
20087
20088
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200898.4. Timing events
20090------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020091
20092Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20093reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20094the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20095frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020096mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20097addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20098
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020099Timings events in HTTP mode:
20100
20101 first request 2nd request
20102 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20103 t tr t tr ...
20104 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20105 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20106 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20107 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020108 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020109 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20110
20111Timings events in TCP mode:
20112
20113 TCP session
20114 |<----------------->|
20115 t t
20116 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20117 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20118 |<------ Tt ------->|
20119
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020120 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020121 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020122 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20123 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20124 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020125 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020126 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20127 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20128 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20129 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020130
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020131 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20132 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20133 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020134 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20135 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20136 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20137 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20138 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20139 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020140
20141 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20142 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20143 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20144 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20145 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20146 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20147 request typed by hand during a test.
20148
20149 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20150 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020151 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020152 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20153 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20154 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20155 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020156
20157 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20158 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20159 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20160 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20161 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20162
20163 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20164 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20165 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20166 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20167 connection never established.
20168
20169 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20170 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20171 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20172 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20173 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20174 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20175 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20176 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20177 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20178 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20179 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20180
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020181 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20182 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20183 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20184 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20185 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20186 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20187
20188 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20189
20190 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20191 "Ta" can never be negative.
20192
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020193 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20194 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020195 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20196 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020197 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020198
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020199 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020200
20201 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020202 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20203 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020204
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020205 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20206 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20207 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20208 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20209 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20210 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20211 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20212 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20213
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020214These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20215protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20216that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020217due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20218"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20219that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020220
20221Most common cases :
20222
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020223 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20224 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20225 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20226 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20227 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
20228 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
20229 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20230 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20231 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20232 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20233 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020234 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020235
20236 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20237 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20238 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20239 of ms on remote networks.
20240
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020241 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20242 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20243 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020244
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020245 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20246 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
20247 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
20248 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20249 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20250 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20251 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20252 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20253 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020254
20255Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20256
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020257 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020258 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020259 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020260
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020261 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020262 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20263 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20264
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020265 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020266 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20267 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20268 flags.
20269
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020270 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20271 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020272 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20273 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20274 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20275 the client connection was maintained open.
20276
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020277 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020278 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020279 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020280 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20281
20282
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202838.5. Session state at disconnection
20284-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020285
20286TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20287"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
202882-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20289each of which has a special meaning :
20290
20291 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20292 session to terminate :
20293
20294 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20295
20296 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20297 server explicitly refused it.
20298
20299 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20300 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20301 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20302 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020303 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020304
20305 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20306 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020307
20308 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20309 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20310 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20311 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20312 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20313
20314 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20315 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20316 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20317 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20318 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20319
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020320 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20321 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20322
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020323 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20324 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20325 backup connections when going up.
20326
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020327 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20328
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020329 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20330 send or receive data.
20331
20332 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20333 send or receive data.
20334
20335 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20336 with nothing left in the buffers.
20337
20338 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20339
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020340 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020341 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20342
20343 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20344 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20345 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20346 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20347 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20348
20349 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20350 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20351
20352 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20353 server (HTTP only).
20354
20355 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20356
20357 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20358 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20359 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20360
20361 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20362 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20363 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20364
20365 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20366
20367 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20368 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20369
20370 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20371 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20372 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20373
20374 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20375 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020376 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20377 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020378
20379 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20380 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20381 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20382 another server.
20383
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020384 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020385 server.
20386
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020387 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20388 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20389 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20390 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20391
20392 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20393 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20394 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20395 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20396
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020397 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20398 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20399 "use-server" rule).
20400
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020401 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20402
20403 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20404 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20405
20406 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20407
20408 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20409 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20410 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20411
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020412 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20413 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020414 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020415 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20416 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20417
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020418 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20419
20420 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20421 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20422
20423 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20424
20425 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20426
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020427The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20428was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020429helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20430starvation, attacks, etc...
20431
20432The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20433alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20434easier finding and understanding.
20435
20436 Flags Reason
20437
20438 -- Normal termination.
20439
20440 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20441 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20442 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20443 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20444
20445 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20446 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20447 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20448 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20449 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20450 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020451
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020452 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20453 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020454 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020455
20456 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20457 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20458 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20459
20460 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20461 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20462 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20463 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20464 the server takes too long to respond.
20465
20466 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20467 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20468 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20469 long a time to respond.
20470
20471 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20472 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20473 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20474 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020475 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20476 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020477
20478 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
20479 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
20480 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
20481 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
20482 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020020483 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020484 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
20485 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
20486 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
20487 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
20488 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
20489 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
20490 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
20491 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020492 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020493 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
20494 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
20495 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020496
20497 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
20498 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020499 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
20500 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
20501 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
20502 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020503
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020504 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
20505 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
20506
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020507 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020508 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
20509 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020510 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020511 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
20512 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
20513
20514 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
20515 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
20516 503 or 504 here.
20517
20518 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
20519 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
20520 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
20521 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
20522 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
20523
20524 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20525 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020526 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020527 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
20528 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
20529
20530 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
20531 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
20532 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
20533 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
20534 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
20535 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
20536 between haproxy and the server.
20537
20538 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
20539 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
20540 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
20541 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
20542 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
20543 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
20544 solution is to fix the application.
20545
20546 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
20547 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
20548 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
20549 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
20550 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
20551 external attacks.
20552
20553 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070020554 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020555 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020556 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
20557 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
20558
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020559 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
20560 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
20561 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020562 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020563 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020564
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020565 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
20566 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
20567 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
20568 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020569 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
20570 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
20571 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
20572 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
20573 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020574
20575 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
20576 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
20577 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
20578 returned an HTTP 403 error.
20579
20580 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
20581 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
20582 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
20583 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
20584
20585 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
20586 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
20587 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
20588 only be solved by proper system tuning.
20589
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020590The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
20591persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
20592important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
20593re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
20594
20595 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
20596
20597 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20598 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
20599 set on a GET request.
20600
20601 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
20602 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020603 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020604 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
20605
20606 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
20607 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
20608 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
20609
20610 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20611 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
20612 already got a cookie.
20613
20614 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20615 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
20616 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
20617 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
20618 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
20619
20620 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20621 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20622 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20623
20624 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
20625 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20626 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20627
20628 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
20629 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
20630
20631 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
20632 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
20633 then advertised in the response.
20634
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206368.6. Non-printable characters
20637-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020638
20639In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
20640consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
20641converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
20642prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
20643being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
20644escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
20645is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
20646'}' when logging headers.
20647
20648Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
20649issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
20650containing spaces is "User-Agent".
20651
20652Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
20653the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
20654performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
20655
20656
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206578.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
20658---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020659
20660Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
20661achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020662section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020663cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
20664the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
20665the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020666locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020667not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
20668user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
20669a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
20670wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
20671
20672 Examples :
20673 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
20674 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
20675
20676 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
20677 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
20678
20679
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206808.8. Capturing HTTP headers
20681---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020682
20683Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
20684proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
20685the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
20686server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
20687
20688Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
20689response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020690section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020691
20692It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020693time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
20694appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020695are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
20696and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
20697follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
20698request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
20699in the logs.
20700
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020701As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
20702frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
20703an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
20704
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020705 Example :
20706 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
20707 listen proxy-out
20708 mode http
20709 option httplog
20710 option logasap
20711 log global
20712 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
20713
20714 # log the name of the virtual server
20715 capture request header Host len 20
20716
20717 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
20718 capture request header Content-Length len 10
20719
20720 # log the beginning of the referrer
20721 capture request header Referer len 20
20722
20723 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
20724 capture response header Server len 20
20725
20726 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
20727 capture response header Content-Length len 10
20728
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020729 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020730 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
20731
20732 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
20733 capture response header Via len 20
20734
20735 # log the URL location during a redirection
20736 capture response header Location len 20
20737
20738 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
20739 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
20740 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20741 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
20742 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
20743
20744 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20745 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20746 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20747 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020748 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020749
20750 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20751 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20752 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20753 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
20754 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020755 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020756
20757
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207588.9. Examples of logs
20759---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020760
20761These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20762them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20763reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20764
20765 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20766 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20767 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20768
20769 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20770 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20771
20772 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20773 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20774 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20775
20776 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20777 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20778
20779 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20780 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20781 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20782
20783 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020784 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020785 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20786 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20787
20788 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20789 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20790 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20791
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020792 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20793 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20794 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20795 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20796 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20797 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020798
20799 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020800 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020801
20802 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20803 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20804 Nothing was sent to any server.
20805
20806 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20807 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20808
20809 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20810 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020811 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020812 send a 408 return code to the client.
20813
20814 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20815 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20816
20817 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20818 5 seconds ("c----").
20819
20820 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20821 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020822 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020823
20824 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020825 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020826 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20827 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20828 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20829 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20830 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020831
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020832
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200208339. Supported filters
20834--------------------
20835
20836Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20837accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20838unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20839
20840See also : "filter"
20841
208429.1. Trace
20843----------
20844
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010020845filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020846
20847 Arguments:
20848 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20849 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20850
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010020851 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020852
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020853 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020854 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20855 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20856 amount of the parsed data.
20857
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020858 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020859
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020860This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20861callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20862information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20863filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20864
20865Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20866tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20867a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20868
20869
208709.2. HTTP compression
20871---------------------
20872
20873filter compression
20874
20875The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20876keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020877when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20878fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20879done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20880explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20881filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20882listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20883order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020884
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020885See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20886 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020887
20888
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200208899.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20890--------------------------------------------
20891
20892filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20893
20894 Arguments :
20895
20896 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20897 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20898 parsed.
20899
20900 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20901 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20902 part must be placed in its own scope.
20903
20904The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20905external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020906streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020907exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20908also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20909
20910SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20911the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20912
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020913For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020914"doc/SPOE.txt".
20915
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100209169.4. Cache
20917----------
20918
20919filter cache <name>
20920
20921 Arguments :
20922
20923 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20924
20925The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20926"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020927cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020928other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20929case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20930is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20931filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020932listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20933order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020934
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020935See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20936 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20937
20938
209399.5. Fcgi-app
20940-------------
20941
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020942filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020943
20944 Arguments :
20945
20946 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20947
20948The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20949request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20950reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20951used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20952implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20953used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20954fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20955used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20956order.
20957
20958See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20959 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20960
20961
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100209629.6. OpenTracing
20963----------------
20964
20965The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
20966HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
20967of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
20968Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
20969
20970This feature is only enabled when haproxy was built with USE_OT=1.
20971
20972The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
20973HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
20974participates in the work of HAProxy.
20975
20976filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
20977
20978 Arguments :
20979
20980 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
20981 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
20982 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
20983 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
20984 OpenTracing filters.
20985
20986 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
20987 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
20988 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
20989 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
20990 filter must have its own scope defined.
20991
20992More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
20993of the filter can be found in the contrib/opentracing directory.
20994
20995
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002099610. FastCGI applications
20997-------------------------
20998
20999HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21000feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21001the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21002FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21003servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21004FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21005backend.
21006
21007HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21008application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21009connection.
21010
2101110.1. Setup
21012-----------
21013
2101410.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21015--------------------------
21016
21017fcgi-app <name>
21018 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21019 document root must be defined.
21020
21021acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21022 Declare or complete an access list.
21023
21024 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21025 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21026 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21027 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21028 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21029
21030docroot <path>
21031 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21032 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21033 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21034
21035index <script-name>
21036 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21037 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21038 is an optional setting.
21039
21040 Example :
21041 index index.php
21042
21043log-stderr global
21044log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021045 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021046 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21047
21048 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21049 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21050
21051pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21052 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21053 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21054 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21055
21056 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21057 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21058 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21059 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21060
21061 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21062 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21063
21064path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021065 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021066 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21067 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21068 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21069 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21070 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21071 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21072 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021073
21074 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021075 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021076 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21077 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21078 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21079 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021080
21081 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021082 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21083 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021084
21085option get-values
21086no option get-values
21087 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21088
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021089 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021090 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21091
21092 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21093 application will accept.
21094
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021095 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21096 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021097
21098 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021099 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021100 option is disabled.
21101
21102 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21103 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21104 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21105 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21106 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21107 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21108
21109option keep-conn
21110no option keep-conn
21111 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21112 sending a response.
21113
21114 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21115 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21116
21117option max-reqs <reqs>
21118 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21119 accept.
21120
21121 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21122 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21123 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21124 to 1.
21125
21126option mpxs-conns
21127no option mpxs-conns
21128 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21129
21130 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21131 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21132
21133set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21134 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21135 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21136 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21137 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21138
21139 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21140 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21141 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21142
21143 Example :
21144 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21145 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21146
21147 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21148
21149
2115010.1.2. Proxy section
21151---------------------
21152
21153use-fcgi-app <name>
21154 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21155
21156 Arguments :
21157 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21158
21159 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21160 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21161 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21162 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21163 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21164
21165 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21166 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21167 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21168 application are evaluated.
21169
21170
2117110.1.3. Example
21172---------------
21173
21174 frontend front-http
21175 mode http
21176 bind *:80
21177 bind *:
21178
21179 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21180 default_backend back-static
21181
21182 backend back-static
21183 mode http
21184 server www A.B.C.D:80
21185
21186 backend back-dynamic
21187 mode http
21188 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21189 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21190
21191 fcgi-app php-fpm
21192 log-stderr global
21193 option keep-conn
21194
21195 docroot /var/www/my-app
21196 index index.php
21197 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21198
21199
2120010.2. Default parameters
21201------------------------
21202
21203A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21204the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021205script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021206applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21207
21208 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21209 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21210 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21211 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21212 | | |
21213 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21214 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21215 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21216 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21217 | | application. |
21218 | | |
21219 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21220 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21221 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21222 | | |
21223 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21224 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21225 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21226 | | the application's configuration. |
21227 | | |
21228 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21229 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21230 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21231 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21232 | | |
21233 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21234 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21235 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21236 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21237 | | be defined. |
21238 | | |
21239 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21240 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21241 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21242 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21243 | | is not set too. |
21244 | | |
21245 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21246 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21247 | | set. |
21248 | | |
21249 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21250 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21251 | | the request. |
21252 | | |
21253 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21254 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21255 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21256 | | |
21257 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21258 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21259 | | script to process the request. |
21260 | | |
21261 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21262 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21263 | | |
21264 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21265 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21266 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21267 | | |
21268 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21269 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21270 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21271 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21272 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21273 | | |
21274 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21275 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21276 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21277 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21278 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21279 | | side. |
21280 | | |
21281 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21282 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21283 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21284 | | connected to. |
21285 | | |
21286 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21287 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21288 | | |
21289 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21290 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
21291 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
21292 | | |
21293 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21294
21295
2129610.3. Limitations
21297------------------
21298
21299The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21300way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21301during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21302establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21303application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21304or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21305message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21306these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21307and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21308
21309Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21310request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21311requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21312
21313About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21314into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21315fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21316"http-request" ones.
21317
21318Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21319FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21320processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21321must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21322here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021323
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021324/*
21325 * Local variables:
21326 * fill-column: 79
21327 * End:
21328 */